blob: 585c6752398f53b1cbf224592fe115978e237dab [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau86512dd2021-04-09 17:10:39 +02007 2021/04/09
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
749See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100751
7522.4. Conditional blocks
753-----------------------
754
755It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
756some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
757ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
758configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
759versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
760preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
761text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
762lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
763switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
764are defined to form conditional blocks:
765
766 - .if <condition>
767 - .elif <condition>
768 - .else
769 - .endif
770
771The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
772as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
773matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
774there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
775only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
776".elif" of a block.
777
778Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
779ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
780as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
781
782The conditions are currently limited to:
783
784 - an empty string, always returns "false"
785 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
786 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
787
788Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
789functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
790
791Three other directives are provided to report some status:
792
793 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
794 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
795 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
796
797Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
798"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
799fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
800provide advice to the user.
801
802Example:
803
804 .if "${A}"
805 .if "${B}"
806 .notice "A=1, B=1"
807 .elif "${C}"
808 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
809 .elif "${D}"
810 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
811 .else
812 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
813 .endif
814 .else
815 .notice "A=0"
816 .endif
817
818
8192.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200820----------------
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100822Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100823values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
824otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
825numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
826for every keyword. Supported units are :
827
828 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
829 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
830 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
831 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
832 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
833 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
834
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008362.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200837-------------
838
839 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
840 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
841 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
842 global
843 daemon
844 maxconn 256
845
846 defaults
847 mode http
848 timeout connect 5000ms
849 timeout client 50000ms
850 timeout server 50000ms
851
852 frontend http-in
853 bind *:80
854 default_backend servers
855
856 backend servers
857 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
858
859
860 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
861 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
862 global
863 daemon
864 maxconn 256
865
866 defaults
867 mode http
868 timeout connect 5000ms
869 timeout client 50000ms
870 timeout server 50000ms
871
872 listen http-in
873 bind *:80
874 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
875
876
877Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
878
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100879 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200880
881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883--------------------
884
885Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
886are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
887of them have command-line equivalents.
888
889The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
890
891 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200892 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200894 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200895 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200897 - description
898 - deviceatlas-json-file
899 - deviceatlas-log-level
900 - deviceatlas-separator
901 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900902 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903 - gid
904 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100905 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200906 - h1-case-adjust
907 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100908 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100909 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100910 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200911 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200913 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100914 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200915 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100916 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100917 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200918 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200920 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200921 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200923 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100924 - presetenv
925 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926 - uid
927 - ulimit-n
928 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200929 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100930 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100931 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200932 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200933 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200934 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200935 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200936 - ssl-default-bind-options
937 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200938 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200939 - ssl-default-server-options
940 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100941 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200942 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100943 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100944 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100945 - 51degrees-data-file
946 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200947 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200948 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200949 - wurfl-data-file
950 - wurfl-information-list
951 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200952 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100953 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100956 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200957 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200959 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100960 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100961 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200963 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200964 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200965 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200966 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200967 - noepoll
968 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000969 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100971 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300972 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000973 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100974 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200975 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200976 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200977 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000978 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000979 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200980 - tune.buffers.limit
981 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200982 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200983 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100984 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200985 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200986 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200987 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200988 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100989 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200990 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200991 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200992 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100993 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100994 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100995 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100996 - tune.lua.session-timeout
997 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200998 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100999 - tune.maxaccept
1000 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001001 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001002 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001003 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001004 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1005 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001006 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1007 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001008 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001009 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001010 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001011 - tune.sndbuf.client
1012 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001013 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001014 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001015 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001016 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001017 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001018 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001019 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001020 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001021 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001022 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001023 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1024 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1025 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001026 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1027 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001029 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001031 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
1033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010343.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035------------------------------------
1036
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001037ca-base <dir>
1038 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001039 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1040 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1041 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043chroot <jail dir>
1044 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1045 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1046 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1047 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1048 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001049 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001050
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001051cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1052 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1053 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1054 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1055 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1056 set. These sets have the format
1057
1058 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1059
1060 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001061 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001062 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1063 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001064 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1065 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001066 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001067 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001068 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001069 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001070 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
1071 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
1072 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
1073 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001074
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001075 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1076 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1077 on the machine's word size.
1078
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001079 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001080 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1081 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1082 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1083 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1084 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1085 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001086
1087 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001088 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1089
1090 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1091 # first 4 CPUs
1092
1093 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1094 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1095 # word size.
1096
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001097 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001099 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1100 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1101 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1102
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001103 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1104 # and so on.
1105 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1106 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1107 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1108
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001109 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001110 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1111 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1112 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1113
1114 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1115 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1116 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1117
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001118 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1119 # and a thread range.
1120 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1121 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1122 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1123
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001124crt-base <dir>
1125 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001126 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1127 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001128
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129daemon
1130 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1131 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001132 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1133 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001135deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1136 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001137 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001138
1139deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001140 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001141 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1142
1143deviceatlas-separator <char>
1144 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1145 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1146
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001147deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001148 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1149 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1150 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001151
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001152external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001153 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1154 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001155 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1156 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1157 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1158 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1159 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001160
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001162 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1164 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001165 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1166 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001167 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001168
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001169group <group name>
1170 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1171 See also "gid" and "user".
1172
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001173hard-stop-after <time>
1174 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1175
1176 Arguments :
1177 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1178 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1179 SIGUSR1 signal.
1180
1181 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1182 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1183 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1184
1185 Example:
1186 global
1187 hard-stop-after 30s
1188
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001189h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1190 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1191 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1192 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1193 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001194 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001195 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1196 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1197 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1198 specified in a proxy.
1199
1200 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1201 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1202 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1203 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1204 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1205 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1206 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1207
1208 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1209 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1210 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1211 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1212 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1213
1214 Example:
1215 global
1216 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1217
1218 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1219 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1220
1221h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1222 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1223 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1224 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1225 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1226 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1227 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1228 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1229 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1230
1231 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1232 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1233 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1234
1235 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1236 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1237
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001238insecure-fork-wanted
1239 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1240 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1241 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1242 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1243 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1244 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1245 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1246 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1247 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1248 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1249 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1250 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1251 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1252 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1253 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1254 disable it.
1255
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001256insecure-setuid-wanted
1257 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1258 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1259 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1260 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1261 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1262 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1263 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1264 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1265 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1266 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1267 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1268 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1269 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1270 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1271
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001272issuers-chain-path <dir>
1273 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1274 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1275 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1276 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1277 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1278 "issuers-chain-path".
1279 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1280 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1281 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1282 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1283 will share the chain in memory.
1284
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001285localpeer <name>
1286 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1287 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1288 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1289 the configuration parsing.
1290
1291 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1292 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1293
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001294log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001295 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001296 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001297 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001298 configured with "log global".
1299
1300 <address> can be one of:
1301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001302 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001303 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1304 port).
1305
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001306 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1307 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1308 port).
1309
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001310 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001311 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1312 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001313 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001314
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001315 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1316 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1317 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1318 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1319 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1320 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1321 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1322 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1323 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1324 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1325 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1326 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1327 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1328 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001329 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1330 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001331
1332 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1333 "fd@2", see above.
1334
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001335 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1336 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1337 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1338 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1339 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1340
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001341 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1342 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001343
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001344 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1345 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1346 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1347 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1348 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1349 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1350 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1351 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1352 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1353 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001354 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1355 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001356
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001357 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1358 one of the following :
1359
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001360 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1361 field is stripped. This is the default.
1362 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1363 rfc3164.
1364
1365 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001366 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1367
1368 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1369 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1370
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001371 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1372 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1373 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1374 designed to be used with a local log server.
1375
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001376 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1377 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1378 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1379 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1380 logger consumes.
1381
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001382 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1383 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1384 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1385 used with a local log server.
1386
1387 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1388 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1389 designed to be used with a local log server.
1390
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001391 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1392 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1393 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1394 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1395
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001396 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1397 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1398 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1399 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1400 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1401
1402 <sample_size>
1403 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1404 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1405 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1406 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1407 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1408
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001409 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001410
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001411 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1412 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1413 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1414
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001415 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1416 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1417 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1418 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
1420 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001421 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1422 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1423 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1424 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1425 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1426 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001428 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001429
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001430log-send-hostname [<string>]
1431 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1432 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1433 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1434 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1435 the logs.
1436
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001437log-tag <string>
1438 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1439 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1440 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001441 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001442
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001443lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001444 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1445 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1446 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1447 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1448 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1449 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001450 used multiple times.
1451
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001452lua-load-per-thread <file>
1453 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1454 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1455 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1456 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1457 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1458 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1459 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1460 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1461 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1462 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1463 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1464 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1465 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1466 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1467 times.
1468
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001469lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1470 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1471 variable.
1472 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1473 to "path".
1474
1475 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1476 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1477 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1478 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1479 will be checked earlier.
1480
1481 As an example by specifying the following path:
1482
1483 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1484 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1485
1486 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1487 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1488 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1489 paths if that does not exist either.
1490
1491 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1492 documentation.
1493
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001494master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001495 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1496 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1497 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001498 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001499 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1500 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001501 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1502 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1503 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1504 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1505 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001506
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001507 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001508
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001509mworker-max-reloads <number>
1510 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001511 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001512 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1513 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1514 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1515
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001516nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001517 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1518 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1519 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001520 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1521 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001522 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1523 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1524 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001526nbthread <number>
1527 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001528 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1529 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1530 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1531 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1532 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001533 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1534 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1535 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1536 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1537 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1538 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1539 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001542 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1543 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1544 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1545 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001546
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001547pp2-never-send-local
1548 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1549 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1550 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1551 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1552 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1553 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1554 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1555 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1556 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1557 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1558 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1559
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001560presetenv <name> <value>
1561 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1562 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1563 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1564 and "unsetenv".
1565
1566resetenv [<name> ...]
1567 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1568 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1569 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1570 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1571 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1572 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1573 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1574 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1575
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001576stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001577 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1578 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1579 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1580 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1581 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1582 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001583 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001584 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1585 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1586 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1587 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001588
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001589server-state-base <directory>
1590 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001591 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1592 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001593
1594server-state-file <file>
1595 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1596 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1597 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1598 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1599 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1600 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1601 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1602 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001603 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1604 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001605
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001606set-var <var-name> <expr>
1607 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1608 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1609 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1610 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1611 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1612 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1613 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1614 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1615 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1616
1617 Example:
1618 global
1619 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1620 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1621 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1622
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001623setenv <name> <value>
1624 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1625 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1626 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1627 and "unsetenv".
1628
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001629set-dumpable
1630 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001631 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1632 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1633 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1634 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1635 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1636 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1637 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1638 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1639 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1640 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1641 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1642 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1643 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1644 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1645 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1646 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1647 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001648
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001649ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1651 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001652 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001653 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001654 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1655 information and recommendations see e.g.
1656 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1657 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1658 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1659 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001660
1661ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1663 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1664 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1665 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1666 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001667 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1668 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1669 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001670 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001671
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001672ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1674 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1675 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1676 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1677 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1678
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001679ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1681 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1682 keyword to see available options.
1683
1684 Example:
1685 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001686 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001687
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001688ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1690 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001691 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001692 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001693 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1694 information and recommendations see e.g.
1695 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1696 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1697 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1698 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1699 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001700
1701ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1703 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1704 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1705 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1706 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001707 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1708 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1709 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1710 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001711
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001712ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1714 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1715 keyword to see available options.
1716
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001717ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1719 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1720 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001721 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001722 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001723 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1724 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1725 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1726 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001727 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1728 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1729 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1730
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001731ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1732 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1733 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001734 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001735 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001736 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1737
1738 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001739
1740 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1741 and won't try to remove them.
1742
1743 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1744
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001745ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001746 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001747 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1748 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001749
1750 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1751 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1752 optimize the startup time.
1753
1754 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1755 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1756 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1757
1758 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001759 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001760
1761 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001762 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1763
1764 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1765 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1766 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1767 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1768 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1769 bind configuration..
1770
1771 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1772 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1773 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1774 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1775 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1776 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1777 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1778 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1779
1780 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1781
1782 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1783 a cert bundle.
1784
1785 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1786 separately in several "crt".
1787
1788 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1789 since files are loading separately.
1790
1791 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1792 required to commit them.
1793
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001794 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001795 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001796
1797 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1798
1799 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1800
1801 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1802 not provided in the PEM file.
1803
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001804 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1805 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1806
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001807 The default behavior is "all".
1808
1809 Example:
1810 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1811 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1812 ssl-load-extra-files none
1813
1814 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1815
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001816ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1817 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1818 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1819 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1820
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001821ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001822 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001823 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1824 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1825 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1826 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1827 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1828 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001829 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001830
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001831stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1832 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1833 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1834 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001835 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001836 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001837
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001838 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1839 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1840 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001841
1842stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1843 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1844 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001845 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001846
1847stats maxconn <connections>
1848 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1849 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001851uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001852 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001853 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1854 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1855 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1856
1857ulimit-n <number>
1858 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1859 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1860 option.
1861
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001862unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1863 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1864
1865 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1866 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1867 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1868 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1869 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1870 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1871 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1872 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1873 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1874 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1875
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001876unsetenv [<name> ...]
1877 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1878 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1879 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1880 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1881 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1882 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1883 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1884
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001885user <user name>
1886 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1887 See also "uid" and "group".
1888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001889node <name>
1890 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1891
1892 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1893 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1894 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1895 traffic.
1896
1897description <text>
1898 Add a text that describes the instance.
1899
1900 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1901 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1902 "<" and ">" characters.
1903
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100190451degrees-data-file <file path>
1905 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001906 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001907
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001908 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001909 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1910
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000191151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001912 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1913 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1914 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1915
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001916 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001917 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1918
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200191951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001920 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1921 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1922
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001923 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1924 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1925
192651degrees-cache-size <number>
1927 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1928 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1929 By default, this cache is disabled.
1930
1931 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001932 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1933
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001934wurfl-data-file <file path>
1935 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1936 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1937
1938 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1939 with USE_WURFL=1.
1940
1941wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1942 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1943 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1944 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1945
1946 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1947
1948 Valid WURFL properties are:
1949 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1950
1951 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1952 device.
1953
1954 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1955 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1956
1957 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1958 particular web request.
1959
1960 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1961 used Libwurfl API version.
1962
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001963 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1964 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1965
1966 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1967 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1968
1969 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1970
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001971 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1972 with USE_WURFL=1.
1973
1974wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1975 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1976 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1977
1978 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1979 with USE_WURFL=1.
1980
1981wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1982 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1983 thus before the chroot.
1984
1985 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1986 with USE_WURFL=1.
1987
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001988wurfl-cache-size <size>
1989 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1990 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001991 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001992 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001993
1994 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1995 with USE_WURFL=1.
1996
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001997strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001998 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1999 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2000 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2001 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2002 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020043.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005-----------------------
2006
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002007busy-polling
2008 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2009 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2010 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2011 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2012 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2013 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2014 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2015 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2016 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2017 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2018 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2019 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2020 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2021 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2022 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2023 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2024 "poll" pollers.
2025
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002026 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2027 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2028 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2029
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002030max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2031 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2032 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2033 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2034 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2035 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2036 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2037 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2038 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2039
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002040maxconn <number>
2041 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2042 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2043 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002044 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2045 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2046 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2047 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002048 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2049 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2050 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2051 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2052 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2053 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002054
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002055maxconnrate <number>
2056 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2057 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2058 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2059 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2060 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2061 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2062 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2063 fairness.
2064
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002065maxcomprate <number>
2066 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002068 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2069 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2070 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002071 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002072 default value.
2073
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002074maxcompcpuusage <number>
2075 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2076 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2077 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2078 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2079 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2080 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2081 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2082 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2083
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002084maxpipes <number>
2085 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2086 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2087 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2088 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2089 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2090 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2091
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002092maxsessrate <number>
2093 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2094 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2095 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2096 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2097 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2098 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2099 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2100 fairness.
2101
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002102maxsslconn <number>
2103 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2104 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2105 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2106 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2107 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2108 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2109 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002110 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2111 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2112 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2113 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2114 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2115 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2116 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002117
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002118maxsslrate <number>
2119 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2120 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2121 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2122 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2123 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2124 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2125 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2126 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2127 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2128 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2129
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002130maxzlibmem <number>
2131 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2132 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2133 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002134 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2135 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2136 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138noepoll
2139 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2140 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002141 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
2143nokqueue
2144 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2145 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2146 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2147
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002148noevports
2149 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2150 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2151 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2152 also "nopoll".
2153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002154nopoll
2155 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2156 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002158 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2159 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002160
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002161nosplice
2162 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002163 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002164 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002165 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002166 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2167 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2168 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2169 "option splice-response".
2170
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002171nogetaddrinfo
2172 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2173 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2174
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002175noreuseport
2176 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2177 command line argument "-dR".
2178
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002179profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2180 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2181 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2182 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2183 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002184 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002185 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2186 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2187 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2188 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2189
2190 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2191 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2192 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2193 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2194 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002195 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2196 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2197 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2198 CLI.
2199
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002200spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002201 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2202 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2203 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2204 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2205 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2206 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002207
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002208ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002209 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002210 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002211 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2212 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2213 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2214 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2215 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002216 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2217 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002218 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2219 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2220 openssl configuration file uses:
2221 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2222
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002223ssl-mode-async
2224 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002225 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002226 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2227 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2228 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002229 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002230 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002231
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002232tune.buffers.limit <number>
2233 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2234 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2235 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2236 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2237 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002238 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002239 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2240 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2241 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2242 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2243 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2244 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2245 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2246 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2247 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2248
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002249tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2250 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2251 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2252 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2253 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2254
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002255tune.bufsize <number>
2256 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2257 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2258 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2259 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2260 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2261 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2262 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002263 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2264 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2265 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002266 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002267 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2268 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2269 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002270
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002271tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2272 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002273
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002274tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2275 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2276 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2277 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2278 this value. The default value is 1.
2279
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002280tune.fail-alloc
2281 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2282 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2283 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2284 gracefully.
2285
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002286tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2287 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2288 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2289 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2290 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2291 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2292
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002293tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2294 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2295 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2296 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2297 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2298 change it.
2299
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002300tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2301 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2303 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002304 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2305 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2306 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2307 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2308 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2309
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002310tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2311 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2312 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2313 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2314 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2315 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2316 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2317 recommended not to change this value.
2318
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002319tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2320 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2321 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2322 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2323 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2324 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2325 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2326 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2327
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002328tune.http.cookielen <number>
2329 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2330 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2331 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2332 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2333 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2334 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2335 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2336 to change this value.
2337
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002338tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2340 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002341 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002342 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002343 configuration directives too.
2344 The default value is 1024.
2345
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002346tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2347 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2348 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2349 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2350 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2351 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2352 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002353 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2354 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2355 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002356
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002357tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2358 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2359 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2360 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2361 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2362 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2363 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002364 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2365 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2366 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2367 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2368 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002369
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002370tune.idletimer <timeout>
2371 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2372 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2373 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2374 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2375 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2376 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002377 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002379 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2380
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002381tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2382 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2383 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2384 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2385 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2386 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2387 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2388 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2389 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2390 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2391
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002392tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2393 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002394 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002395 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2396 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002397 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002398 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2399 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2400
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002401tune.lua.maxmem
2402 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2403 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2404 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2405 memory.
2406
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002407tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2408 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002409 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2410 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002412
2413tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2414 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2415 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2416 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2417 check servers.
2418
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002419tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2420 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2421 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2422 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002423 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002424
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002425tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002426 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2427 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002428 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2429 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2430 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2431 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2432 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2433 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2434 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2435 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2436 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002437
2438tune.maxpollevents <number>
2439 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2440 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2441 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2442 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2443 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2444
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002445tune.maxrewrite <number>
2446 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2447 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2448 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2449 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2450 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2451 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2452 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2453 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2454 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2455 bufsize.
2456
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002457tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2458 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2459 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2460 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2461 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2462 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2463 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2464 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2465 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2466 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002467 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2468 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002469 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2470 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2471 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2472 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2473 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2474 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2475 setting this parameter to 0.
2476
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002477tune.pipesize <number>
2478 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2479 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2480 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2481 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2482 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2483 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2484
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002485tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2486 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2487 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2488 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2489 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2490 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2491 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002492 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002493
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002494tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2495 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2496 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2497 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2498 default is 20.
2499
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002500tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2501tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2502 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2503 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2504 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002505 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002506 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002507 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2508 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2509
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002510tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002511 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002512 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2513 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2514 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2515 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2516
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002517tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002518 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002519 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2520 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2521 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2522 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2523 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2524 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2525 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002526
2527tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2528 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2529 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2530 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2531 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2532 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2533 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2534 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2535 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2536 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002537
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002538tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2539tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2540 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2541 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2542 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002543 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002544 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002545 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2546 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2547 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2548 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2549 notifying haproxy again.
2550
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002551tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002552 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002553 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2554 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2555 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2556 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2557 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2558 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2559 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2560 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2561 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2562 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2563 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002564
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002565tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002566 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002567 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2568 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2569 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2570 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2571 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2572
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002573tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2574 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2575 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2576 performances. This is disabled by default.
2577
2578 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2579 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2580
2581 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2582
2583 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2584
2585 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2586
2587 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2588 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2589 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2590
2591 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2592 converted.
2593
2594 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2595 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2596 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2597 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2598 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2599 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2600 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002601 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2602 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002603
2604 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2605
2606 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2607 only need this line:
2608
2609 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2610
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002611tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2612 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002613 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002614 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2615 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2616 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2617 being used for too long.
2618
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002619tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2620 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2621 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2622 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2623 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2624 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2625 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2626 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2627 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2628 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2629 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002630 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002631 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002632
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002633tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2634 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2635 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2636 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2637 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002638 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002639 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2640 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002641 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2642 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002643
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002644tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2645 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2646 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2647 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2648 1000 entries.
2649
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002650tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2651 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2652 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2653 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2654
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002655tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002656tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002657tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2658tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2659tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002660 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2661 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2662 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2663 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2664 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2665 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2666 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2667 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002668
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002669 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2670 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2671 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2672 all available space is consumed.
2673 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2674 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2675 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002676
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002677tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2678 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002679 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002680 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002681 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002682 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2683
2684tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2685 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2686 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002687 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2688 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026903.3. Debugging
2691--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002692
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002693quiet
2694 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2695 line argument "-q".
2696
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002697zero-warning
2698 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2699 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2700 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2701 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2702 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2703 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2704
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010027063.4. Userlists
2707--------------
2708It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2709http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2710it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2711
2712userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002713 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002714 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2715
2716group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002717 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002718 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2719 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2720
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002721user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2722 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002723 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2724 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002725 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2726 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2727 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2728 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002729
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002730 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2731 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2732 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2733 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2734 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2735 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2736 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2737 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2738 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002739
2740 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002741 userlist L1
2742 group G1 users tiger,scott
2743 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002744
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002745 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2746 user scott insecure-password elgato
2747 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002748
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002749 userlist L2
2750 group G1
2751 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002752
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002753 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2754 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2755 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002756
2757 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002758
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002759
27603.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002761----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002762It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2763several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2764instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2765values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2766automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2767In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2768using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2769tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2770reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2771Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2772that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2773each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002774
2775peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002776 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002777 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2778
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002779bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2780 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2781 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2782
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002783disabled
2784 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2785 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2786 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2787
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002788default-bind [param*]
2789 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2790
2791default-server [param*]
2792 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2793
2794 Arguments:
2795 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2796 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2797 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2798 details.
2799
2800
2801 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2802
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002803enable
2804 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2805
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002806log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002807 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2808 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2809 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2810 more details.
2811
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002812peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002813 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2814 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002815 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2816 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2817 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2818 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2819 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002820
2821 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2822 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2823
2824 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002825 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2826 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2827 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002828
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002829 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2830 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002831
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002832 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2833 "server" keyword explanation below).
2834
2835server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002836 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002837 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2838 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2839 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2840 of this "peers" section).
2841 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2842
2843
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002844 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002845 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002846 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002847 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2848 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2849 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002850
2851 backend mybackend
2852 mode tcp
2853 balance roundrobin
2854 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2855 stick on src
2856
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002857 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2858 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002859
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002860 Example:
2861 peers mypeers
2862 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2863 default-server ssl verify none
2864 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2865 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002866
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002867
2868table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2869 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2870
2871 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2872 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002873 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002874 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2875 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2876 "stick-table" keyword).
2877
2878 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2879 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2880 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2881 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2882 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2883 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2884 of the stick-table name as follows:
2885
2886 peers mypeers
2887 peer A ...
2888 peer B ...
2889 table t1 ...
2890
2891 frontend fe1
2892 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2893
2894 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2895 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2896
2897 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2898 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2899 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2900 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2901 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2902 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2903 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2904
2905 peers mypeers
2906 peer A ...
2907 peer B ...
2908 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2909
2910 backend t1
2911 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2912
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002913 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002914 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2915 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2916
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090029173.6. Mailers
2918------------
2919It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2920If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2921in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2922
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002923mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002924 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2925 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2926
2927mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2928 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2929
2930 Example:
2931 mailers mymailers
2932 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2933 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2934
2935 backend mybackend
2936 mode tcp
2937 balance roundrobin
2938
2939 email-alert mailers mymailers
2940 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2941 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2942
2943 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2944 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2945
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002946timeout mail <time>
2947 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2948 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2949 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2950 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2951
2952 Example:
2953 mailers mymailers
2954 timeout mail 20s
2955 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002956
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029573.7. Programs
2958-------------
2959In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2960master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2961managed the same way as the workers.
2962
2963During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2964sequence as a worker:
2965
2966 - the master is re-executed
2967 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2968 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2969 instance of the program
2970
2971During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2972
2973program <name>
2974 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2975 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2976 the management guide).
2977
2978command <command> [arguments*]
2979 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2980 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2981 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2982 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2983
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002984user <user name>
2985 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2986 See also "group".
2987
2988group <group name>
2989 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2990 See also "user".
2991
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002992option start-on-reload
2993no option start-on-reload
2994 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2995 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2996 program section.
2997
2998
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010029993.8. HTTP-errors
3000----------------
3001
3002It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3003imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3004several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3005
3006http-errors <name>
3007 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3008 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3009
3010errorfile <code> <file>
3011 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3012
3013 Arguments :
3014 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003015 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003016 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003017
3018 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3019 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3020 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3021 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3022 before any chroot is performed.
3023
3024 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3025
3026 Example:
3027 http-errors website-1
3028 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3029 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3030 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3031
3032 http-errors website-2
3033 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3034 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3035 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3036
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030373.9. Rings
3038----------
3039
3040It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3041servers or traces.
3042
3043ring <ringname>
3044 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3045
3046description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003047 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003048 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3049
3050format <format>
3051 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3052
3053 Arguments:
3054 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3055 one of the following :
3056
3057 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3058 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3059 designed to be used with a local log server.
3060
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003061 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3062 field is stripped. This is the default.
3063 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3064 rfc3164.
3065
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003066 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3067 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3068 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3069 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3070 is the default.
3071
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003072 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003073 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3074
3075 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3076 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3077
3078 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3079 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3080 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3081 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3082 logger consumes.
3083
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003084 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3085 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3086 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3087 with a local log server.
3088
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003089 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3090 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3091 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3092 used with a local log server.
3093
3094maxlen <length>
3095 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3096 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3097 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3098
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003099server <name> <address> [param*]
3100 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3101 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3102 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3103 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3104 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3105 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3106 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3107 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3108 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003109 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3110 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003111
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003112size <size>
3113 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3114 set to BUFSIZE.
3115
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003116timeout connect <timeout>
3117 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3118
3119 Arguments :
3120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3122 as explained at the top of this document.
3123
3124timeout server <timeout>
3125 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3126
3127 Arguments :
3128 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3130 as explained at the top of this document.
3131
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003132 Example:
3133 global
3134 log ring@myring local7
3135
3136 ring myring
3137 description "My local buffer"
3138 format rfc3164
3139 maxlen 1200
3140 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003141 timeout connect 5s
3142 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003143 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003144
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031453.10. Log forwarding
3146-------------------
3147
3148It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3149haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3150
3151log-forward <name>
3152 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3153
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003154backlog <conns>
3155 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3156 on connections accept.
3157
3158bind <addr> [param*]
3159 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003160 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3161 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3162 syslog protocol over TCP.
3163 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003164 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3165
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003166dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003167 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3168 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3169 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3170 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003171 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003172
3173log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003174log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003175 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3176 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3177 documentation.
3178 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3179 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3180 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3181 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3182 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3183
3184 Example:
3185 global
3186 log stderr format iso local7
3187
3188 ring myring
3189 description "My local buffer"
3190 format rfc5424
3191 maxlen 1200
3192 size 32764
3193 timeout connect 5s
3194 timeout server 10s
3195 # syslog tcp server
3196 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3197
3198 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003199 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3200 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003201 # all messages on stderr
3202 log global
3203 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3204 log ring@myring local0
3205 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3206 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3207 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3208 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3209 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003210
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003211maxconn <conns>
3212 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3213 10 is the default.
3214
3215timeout client <timeout>
3216 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032184. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003219----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003221Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003222 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3223 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3224 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3225 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003226
3227A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3228connections.
3229
3230A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3231to forward incoming connections.
3232
3233A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3234parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3235
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003236A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3237ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3238sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3239the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3240explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3241from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3242"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3243for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3244to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3245optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3246are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3247any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3248names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3249that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3250duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3251names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3252
3253Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3254settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3255of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3256profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3257timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3260'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3261case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3262
3263Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3264logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3265proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3266However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3267name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3268
3269Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3270and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003271bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003272protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3273modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3274arbitrary criteria.
3275
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003276In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3277a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003278the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003279
3280 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3281 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3282 between responses and new requests.
3283
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003284 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3285 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3286 client-facing connection remains open.
3287
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003288 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3289 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003290
3291The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3292frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3293following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003294weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003295
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003296 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003297
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003298 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3299 ----+-----+-----+----
3300 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3301 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003302 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3303 ----+-----+-----+----
3304 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003305
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003306It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3307only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3308into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3309as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3310content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3311and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3312possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003314There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3315first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3316processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3317second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3318protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3319is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3320new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3321to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3322process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3323already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3324HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3325evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3326one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3327
3328There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3329performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3330tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3331preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3332analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3333HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3334header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3335mitigate this drawback.
3336
3337It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3338method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3339set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3340in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3341is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3342to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3343above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3344to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3345"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3346frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3347frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3348as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3349upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3350on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3351the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3352upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3353frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3354remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3357--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003359The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3360limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3361they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3362limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003363marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003364option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003365and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3366with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3367specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003369
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3371------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3372acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003373backlog X X X -
3374balance X - X X
3375bind - X X -
3376bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003377capture cookie - X X -
3378capture request header - X X -
3379capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003380clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3381clitcpka-idle X X X -
3382clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003383compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003385declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003386default-server X - X X
3387default_backend X X X -
3388description - X X X
3389disabled X X X X
3390dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003391email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003392email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003393email-alert mailers X X X X
3394email-alert myhostname X X X X
3395email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003396enabled X X X X
3397errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003398errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003399errorloc X X X X
3400errorloc302 X X X X
3401-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3402errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003403force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003404filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003405fullconn X - X X
3406grace X X X X
3407hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003408http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003409http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003410http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003411http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003412http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003413http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003414http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003415http-check set-var X - X X
3416http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003417http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003418http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003419http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003420http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003421http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003422id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003423ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003424load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003425log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003426log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003427log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003428log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003429max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003430maxconn X X X -
3431mode X X X X
3432monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003433monitor-uri X X X -
3434option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3435option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3436option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3437option allbackups (*) X - X X
3438option checkcache (*) X - X X
3439option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3440option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003441option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003442option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3443option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003444-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3445option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003446option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3447option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003448option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003449option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003450option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003451option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003452option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003453option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3454option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3455option httpchk X - X X
3456option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003457option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003458option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003459option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003460option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003461option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003462option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3463option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3464option logasap (*) X X X -
3465option mysql-check X - X X
3466option nolinger (*) X X X X
3467option originalto X X X X
3468option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003469option pgsql-check X - X X
3470option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003471option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003472option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003473option smtpchk X - X X
3474option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3475option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3476option splice-request (*) X X X X
3477option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003478option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003479option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3480option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3481-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003482option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003483option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3484option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3485option tcpka X X X X
3486option tcplog X X X X
3487option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003488external-check command X - X X
3489external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003490persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3491rate-limit sessions X X X -
3492redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003493-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003494retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003495retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003496server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003497server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003498server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003499source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003500srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3501srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3502srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003503stats admin - X X X
3504stats auth X X X X
3505stats enable X X X X
3506stats hide-version X X X X
3507stats http-request - X X X
3508stats realm X X X X
3509stats refresh X X X X
3510stats scope X X X X
3511stats show-desc X X X X
3512stats show-legends X X X X
3513stats show-node X X X X
3514stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003515-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3516stick match - - X X
3517stick on - - X X
3518stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003519stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003520stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003521tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003522tcp-check connect X - X X
3523tcp-check expect X - X X
3524tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003525tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003526tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003527tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003528tcp-check set-var X - X X
3529tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003530tcp-request connection - X X -
3531tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003532tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003533tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003534tcp-response content - - X X
3535tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003536timeout check X - X X
3537timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003538timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003539timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003540timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3541timeout http-request X X X X
3542timeout queue X - X X
3543timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003544timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003546timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003548unique-id-format X X X -
3549unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003550use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003551use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003552use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003553------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3554 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3558---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559
3560This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3561
3562
3563acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3564 Declare or complete an access list.
3565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3566 no | yes | yes | yes
3567 Example:
3568 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3569 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3570 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003572 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573
3574
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003575backlog <conns>
3576 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3578 yes | yes | yes | no
3579 Arguments :
3580 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3581 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003582 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003583
3584 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3585 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3586 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3587 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3588 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3589 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3590 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3591 backlog parameter.
3592
3593 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3594 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3595 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3596
3597 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3598
3599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003601balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | no | yes | yes
3605 Arguments :
3606 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3607 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3608 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3609 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3610
3611 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3612 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3613 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3614 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003615 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003616 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003617 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3618 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3619 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3620 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3621 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3622 it, so that you don't worry.
3623
3624 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3625 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3626 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3627 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3628 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3629 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3630 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3631 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003633 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3634 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3635 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3636 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3637 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3638 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3639 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003640 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3641 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3642 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003643
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003644 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003645 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003646 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3647 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003648 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003649 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3650 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3651 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3652 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3653 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003654 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3655 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3656 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3657 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3658 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3659 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3662 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3663 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3664 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3665 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3666 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3667 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3668 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003669 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003671 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3672 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3673 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003675 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3676 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3677 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3678 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3679 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3680 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3681 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3682 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3683 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3684 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3685 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3686 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003688 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003689 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3690 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3691 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3692 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3693 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3694 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3695 URIs start with a leading "/".
3696
3697 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3698 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3699 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3700 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3701
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003702 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3703 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3704 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3705 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003708 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3709
3710 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003711 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3712 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003713 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3714 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3715 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3716 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003717 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003718 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3719 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003720
3721 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3722 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3723 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3724 server will receive the request.
3725
3726 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3727 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3728 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3729 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3730 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003731 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3732 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3733 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003735 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3736 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3737 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3738 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3739 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003741 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003742 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3743 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3744 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3745
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003746 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3747 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3748 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3749
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003750 random
3751 random(<draws>)
3752 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003753 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3754 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3755 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3756 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003757 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3758 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3759 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3760 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3761 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3762 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3763 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3764 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3765 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3766 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3767 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3768 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3769 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3770 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3771 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3772 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3773 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3774 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3775 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3776 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003777
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003778 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003779 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003780 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3781 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3782 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3783 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3784 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3785 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003786 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003787 used instead.
3788
3789 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3790 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3791 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3792 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3793
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003794 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3795 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3796 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3797
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003798 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003800 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003801 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3802 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003803
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003804 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3805 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3806 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003808 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003809 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003810 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3811 NTLM relies on.
3812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813 Examples :
3814 balance roundrobin
3815 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003816 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003817 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3818 balance hdr(host)
3819 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003820
3821 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3822 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003824 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003825 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3826 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3827 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003828 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003829
3830 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3831 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3832 defaults to 16 kB.
3833
3834 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3835 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3836
3837 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3838 Round Robin.
3839
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003840 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003841 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3842 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3843 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3844
3845 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3846
3847 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003848 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003849 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3850 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3851 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003852
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003853 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854
3855
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003856bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3857bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3860 no | yes | yes | no
3861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003862 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3863 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3864 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3865 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003866 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003867 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3868 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3869 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3870 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3871 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3872 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003873 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003874 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3875 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003876 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003877 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3878 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003879 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003880 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3881 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003882 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003883 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3884 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3885 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3886 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3887 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3888 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3889 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003890 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3891 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3892 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003893 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3894 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3895 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3896 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003897 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3898 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3899 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003900
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003901 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3902 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003903 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3904 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3905 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003906 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3907 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3908 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3909 the range.
3910
3911 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3912 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3913 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3914 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3915 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3916 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3917 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003918 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003919 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003921 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003922 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003923 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3924 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3925 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3926 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3927 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3928 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003930 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3931 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3932 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3933 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3936 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3937 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3938 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3939 in a frontend.
3940
3941 Example :
3942 listen http_proxy
3943 bind :80,:443
3944 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003945 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003947 listen http_https_proxy
3948 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003949 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003950
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003951 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3952 bind ipv6@:80
3953 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3954 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3955
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003956 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003957 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003958
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003959 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3960 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3961 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3962 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3963 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3964
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003965 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003966 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003967
3968
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003969bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003970 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3972 yes | yes | yes | yes
3973 Arguments :
3974 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3975 may be used to override a default value.
3976
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003977 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003978 option may be combined with other numbers.
3979
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003980 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003981 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3982 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3983 missing from all processes.
3984
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003985 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003986 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003987 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3988 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3989 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3990 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3991 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003992 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003993
3994 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3995 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3996 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3997 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3998 and 'even' instances.
3999
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004000 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4001 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4002 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4003 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004004
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004005 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4006 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4007
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004008 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4009 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4010 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4011
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004012 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4013 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4014
4015 Example :
4016 listen app_ip1
4017 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004018 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004019
4020 listen app_ip2
4021 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004022 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004023
4024 listen management
4025 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004026 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004027
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004028 listen management
4029 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4030 bind-process 1-4
4031
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004032 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004033
4034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035capture cookie <name> len <length>
4036 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4038 no | yes | yes | no
4039 Arguments :
4040 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4041 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4042 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4043 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004044 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004045
4046 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4047 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4048 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4049 right if it exceeds <length>.
4050
4051 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4052 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4053 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4054 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4055
4056 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4057 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4058 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4059
4060 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4061 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4062 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004063 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4064 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4065 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004066
4067 Example:
4068 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4069
4070 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004071 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
4073
4074capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004075 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 no | yes | yes | no
4078 Arguments :
4079 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004080 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004081 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4082 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4083 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4084
4085 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4086 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4087 it exceeds <length>.
4088
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004089 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4091 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004092 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4093 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4094 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4095 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004096 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004097 environments to find where the request came from.
4098
4099 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4100 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4101 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4102 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004104 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4105 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4106 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4107 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4108 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109
4110 Example:
4111 capture request header Host len 15
4112 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004113 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004115 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116 about logging.
4117
4118
4119capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004120 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 no | yes | yes | no
4123 Arguments :
4124 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004125 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4127 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4128 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4129
4130 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4131 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4132 it exceeds <length>.
4133
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004134 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4136 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4137 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004138 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4139 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4140 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4141 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004143 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4144 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4145 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4146 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4147 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
4149 Example:
4150 capture response header Content-length len 9
4151 capture response header Location len 15
4152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004153 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004154 about logging.
4155
4156
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004157clitcpka-cnt <count>
4158 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4159 the connection on the client side.
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | yes | yes | no
4162 Arguments :
4163 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4164
4165 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4166 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004167 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4168 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004169
4170 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4171
4172
4173clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4174 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4175 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4176 client side.
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | no
4179 Arguments :
4180 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4181 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4182 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4183 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4184
4185 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4186 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004187 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4188 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004189
4190 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4191
4192
4193clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4194 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 yes | yes | yes | no
4197 Arguments :
4198 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4199 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4200 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4201 document.
4202
4203 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4204 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004205 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4206 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004207
4208 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4209
4210
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004211compression algo <algorithm> ...
4212compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004213compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004214 Enable HTTP compression.
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | yes | yes | yes
4217 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004218 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4219 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4220 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4221
4222 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004223 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4224 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4225 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004226
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004227 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004228 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004229
4230 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4231 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4232 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4233 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4234 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004235 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004236
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004237 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4238 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4239 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4240 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4241 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4242 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4243 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004244 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004245
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004246 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004247 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004248 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4249 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4250 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4251 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4252 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004253
4254 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4255 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4256 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4257 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4258 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004259 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4260 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4261 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4262 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4263 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004264 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4265 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004266
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004267 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004268 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4269 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004270 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004271 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004272 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4273 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4274 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4275 "multipart"
4276 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4277 header
4278 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4279 and later
4280 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4281 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004282 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004283
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004284 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004285
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004286 Examples :
4287 compression algo gzip
4288 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004289
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004291cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004292 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4293 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004294 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | no | yes | yes
4298 Arguments :
4299 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4300 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4301 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4302 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4303 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4304 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004305 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004306 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4307 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4308
4309 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4310 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4311 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4312 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4313 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4314 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004315 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4316 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004317 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004318 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4319 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
4321 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004322 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004323
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004324 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004325 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004326 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004327 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004328 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4329 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4330 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4331 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4332 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4333 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4334 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335
4336 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4337 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4338 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4339 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4340 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4341 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4342 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4343 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4344 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004345 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004346 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4347 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4348 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004350 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4351 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4352 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004353 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4354 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4355 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4356 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004357 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4358 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4359 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360
4361 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4362 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4363 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4364 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4365 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4366 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4367 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4368 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4369 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4370
4371 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4372 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4373 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4374 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4375 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4376 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4377 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4378 persistence cookie in the cache.
4379 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4380
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004381 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4382 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4383 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4384 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4385 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004386 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004387 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4388 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4389 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4390 they logout.
4391
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004392 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4393 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4394 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4395 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4396
4397 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4398 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4399 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4400 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4401 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4402 this attribute.
4403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004404 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004405 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004406 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4407 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4408 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4409 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4410 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4411 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004413 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4414 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4415 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4416 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4417 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4418 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4419 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4420 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004421 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004422 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4423 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4424 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4425 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4426 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4427 the site.
4428
4429 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4430 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4431 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4432 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4433 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4434 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4435 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4436 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4437 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4438 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4439 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4440 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4441 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004442 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004443 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4444 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4445
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004446 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4447 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4448 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4449 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4450 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4451 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4452
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004453 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4454 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4455 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4456 repeated.
4457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4459 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4460 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4461 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463 Examples :
4464 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4465 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4466 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004467 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004468
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004469 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004470
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004471
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004472declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4473 Declares a capture slot.
4474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4475 no | yes | yes | no
4476 Arguments:
4477 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4478
4479 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4480 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4481 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4482 for use in the response.
4483
4484 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004485 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004486 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4487
4488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004489default-server [param*]
4490 Change default options for a server in a backend
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 yes | no | yes | yes
4493 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004494 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4495 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4496 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4497 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004498
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004499 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004500 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4501
4502 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004503
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505default_backend <backend>
4506 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | yes | yes | no
4509 Arguments :
4510 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4511
4512 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4513 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4514 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4515 will catch all undetermined requests.
4516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 Example :
4518
4519 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4520 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4521 default_backend dynamic
4522
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004523 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004525
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004526description <string>
4527 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 no | yes | yes | yes
4530 Arguments : string
4531
4532 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4533 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4534 it describes.
4535 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4536
4537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538disabled
4539 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 yes | yes | yes | yes
4542 Arguments : none
4543
4544 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4545 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4546 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4547 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4548 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4549 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4550 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4551
4552 See also : "enabled"
4553
4554
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004555dispatch <address>:<port>
4556 Set a default server address
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004559 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004560
4561 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4562 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4563 during start-up.
4564
4565 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4566 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4567 possible with normal servers.
4568
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004569 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004570 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4571 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4572 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4573 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4574
4575 See also : "server"
4576
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004577
4578dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4579 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | no | yes | yes
4582 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4583
4584 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004585 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004586 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4587 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004588 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004589 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004591enabled
4592 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4594 yes | yes | yes | yes
4595 Arguments : none
4596
4597 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4598 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4599
4600 See also : "disabled"
4601
4602
4603errorfile <code> <file>
4604 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4606 yes | yes | yes | yes
4607 Arguments :
4608 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004609 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004610 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611
4612 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004613 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004614 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004615 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4616 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004617
4618 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4619 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4620 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4621
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004622 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4623
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004624 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4625 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4626 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4627 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4628 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4629 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4630 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4631 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4632 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004634 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4635 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4636 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004637 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004638 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4639
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004640 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004641
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004642 Example :
4643 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004644 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004645 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4646 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004648
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004649errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4650 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4651 section.
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 yes | yes | yes | yes
4654 Arguments :
4655 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4656
4657 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004658 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004659 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4660 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004661
4662 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4663 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4664 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4665 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4666 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004667 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004668 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4669
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004670 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4671 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004672
4673 Example :
4674 errorfiles generic
4675 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4676
4677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004678errorloc <code> <url>
4679errorloc302 <code> <url>
4680 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4682 yes | yes | yes | yes
4683 Arguments :
4684 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004685 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004686 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004687
4688 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4689 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4690 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4691 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004692 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004693
4694 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4695 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4696 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4697
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004698 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004700 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4701 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4702 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4703 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004704 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004705 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4706 request.
4707
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004708 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004709
4710
4711errorloc303 <code> <url>
4712 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | yes
4715 Arguments :
4716 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004717 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004718 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
4720 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4721 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4722 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4723 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004724 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725
4726 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4727 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4728 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004730 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004732 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4733 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4734 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4735 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004736 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004738 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739
4740
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004741email-alert from <emailaddr>
4742 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004743 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | yes | yes | yes
4746
4747 Arguments :
4748
4749 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4750
4751 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4752 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4753
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004754 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004755 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4756 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004757
4758
4759email-alert level <level>
4760 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4761 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | yes | yes | yes
4764
4765 Arguments :
4766
4767 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4768 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4769 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4770
4771 By default level is alert
4772
4773 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4774 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4775 for the proxy.
4776
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004777 Alerts are sent when :
4778
4779 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4780 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4781 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4782 is notice or lower
4783 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4784 and a health check status update occurs
4785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004786 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4787 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004788 section 3.6 about mailers.
4789
4790
4791email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4792 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 yes | yes | yes | yes
4795
4796 Arguments :
4797
4798 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4799
4800 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4801 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4802
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004803 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4804 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004805
4806
4807email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4808 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4809 mailers.
4810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | yes
4812
4813 Arguments :
4814
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004815 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004816
4817 By default the systems hostname is used.
4818
4819 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4820 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4821 for the proxy.
4822
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004823 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4824 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004825
4826
4827email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004828 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004829 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 yes | yes | yes | yes
4832
4833 Arguments :
4834
4835 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4836
4837 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4838 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4839
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004840 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004841 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4842
4843
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004844force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4845 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004847 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004848
4849 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4850 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4851 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4852 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4853 marked down for maintenance operations.
4854
4855 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4856 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4857 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4858 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4859 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4860 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4861 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4862 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4863 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4864
4865 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4866 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4867 is used.
4868
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004869 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004870 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004871
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004872
4873filter <name> [param*]
4874 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4876 no | yes | yes | yes
4877 Arguments :
4878 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4879 referenced in section 9.
4880
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004881 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004882 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004883 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4884 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004885
4886 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4887 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4888
4889 Example:
4890 listen
4891 bind *:80
4892
4893 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4894 filter compression
4895 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4896
4897 compression algo gzip
4898 compression offload
4899
4900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4901
4902 See also : section 9.
4903
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004904
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004905fullconn <conns>
4906 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | no | yes | yes
4909 Arguments :
4910 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4911 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4912
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004913 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004914 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004915 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4917 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4918 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4919 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4920 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004921 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004922
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004923 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4924 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004925 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4926 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4927 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004929 Example :
4930 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4931 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4932 # connections.
4933 backend dynamic
4934 fullconn 10000
4935 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4936 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4937
4938 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4939
4940
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004941grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004944 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945 Arguments :
4946 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4947 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4948 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4949
4950 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4951 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004952 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004953 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4954
4955 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4956 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4957 simplify it.
4958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004959
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004960hash-balance-factor <factor>
4961 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | no | no | yes
4964 Arguments :
4965 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4966 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004967 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004968
4969 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4970 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4971 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4972 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4973 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4974 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4975 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4976
4977 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4978 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4979 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4980 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4981 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4982
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004983 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4984 consistent hashing mechanism.
4985
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004986 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4987
4988
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004989hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004990 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4992 yes | no | yes | yes
4993 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004994 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4995 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004996
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004997 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4998 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4999 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5000 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5001 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5002 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5003 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5004 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5005 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5006 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005007
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005008 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5009 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5010 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5011 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5012 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5013 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5014 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5015 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5016 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5017 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5018 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5019 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5020 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005021 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5022 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005023
5024 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5025
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005026 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005027 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5028 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5029 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005030 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5031 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5032 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005033
5034 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5035 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005036 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5037 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5038 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5039 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5040
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005041 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5042 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5043 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5044 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5045 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5046 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5047 parameter.
5048
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005049 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5050 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5051 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5052 used on strings.
5053
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005054 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5055
5056 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5057 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5058 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5059 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5060 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5061 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5062 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5063 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5064 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5065 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5066 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5067 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005068
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005069 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5070 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5071 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005072
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005073 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005074
5075
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005076http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5077 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5078 ones).
5079
5080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5081 no | yes | yes | yes
5082
5083 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5084 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5085 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5086 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5087 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5088 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5089
5090 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5091 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5092 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5093
5094 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5095 below.
5096
5097 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5098 instance.
5099
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005100 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5101 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5102 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5103
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005104 Example:
5105 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5106 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5107 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5108
5109http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5110
5111 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5112 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5113 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5114 example, or to pass some internal information.
5115 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5116 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5117 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5118
5119http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5120
5121 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5122 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5123
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005124http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005126 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5127 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5128 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5129 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5130 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005131
5132http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5134
5135 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5136
5137 Example:
5138 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5139
5140 # applied to:
5141 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5142
5143 # outputs:
5144 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5145
5146 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5147
5148http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5150
5151 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5152
5153 Example:
5154 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5155
5156 # applied to:
5157 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5158
5159 # outputs:
5160 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5161
5162http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5163
5164 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5165 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5166 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5167
5168http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5170
5171 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5172 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5173 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5174 fallback.
5175
5176 Example:
5177 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5178 http-response set-status 431
5179 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5180 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5181
5182http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5183
5184 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5185 inline.
5186
5187 Arguments:
5188 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5189 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5190 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5191 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5192 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5193 (request and response)
5194 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5195 processing
5196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5197 processing
5198 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5199 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5200 and '_'.
5201
5202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5203 followed by some converters.
5204
5205 Example:
5206 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5207
5208http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5209
5210 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5211 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5212 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5213 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5214 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005215 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005216 processing.
5217
5218 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5219 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005220 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005221 rules evaluation.
5222
5223http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224
5225 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5226 details about <var-name>.
5227
5228 Example:
5229 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5230
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005231
5232http-check comment <string>
5233 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5234 it fails.
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | no | yes | yes
5237
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005238 Arguments :
5239 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5240 rule fails.
5241
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005242 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5243 user-friendly error reporting.
5244
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005245 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005246 "http-check expect".
5247
5248
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005249http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5250 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005251 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005252 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5254 yes | no | yes | yes
5255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005256 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005257 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5258
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005259 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005260 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005261
5262 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5263 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5264 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5265 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5266
5267 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5268
5269 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5270
5271 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5272
5273 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5274
5275 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5276
5277 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5278 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5279 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5280 is used.
5281
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005282 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5283 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5284 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5285 haproxy -vv.
5286
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005287 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5288
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005289 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5290 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5291 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5292 different ports or with different servers.
5293
5294 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5295 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5296 the port with a "http-check connect".
5297
5298 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5299 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5300 do.
5301
5302 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5303 unset-var or comment rules.
5304
5305 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005306 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5307 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5308 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5309 option httpchk
5310
5311 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005312 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005313 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005314 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005315 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005316 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005317
5318 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5319
5320 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005321
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005323http-check disable-on-404
5324 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005326 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005327 Arguments : none
5328
5329 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5330 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5331 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5332 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5333 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5334 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5335 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5336 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005337 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5338 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005339 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5340 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5341 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005342
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005343 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005344
5345
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005346http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005347 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5348 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5349 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005350 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005352 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005353
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005354 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005355 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5356
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005357 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5358 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5359 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5360 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5361 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5362 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5363 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5364 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5365 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5366 result is always conclusive.
5367
5368 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5369 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5370 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005371 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5372 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005373 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5374 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005375 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5376 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5377 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005378
5379 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5380 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005381 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5382 supported :
5383 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5384 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005385 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5386 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5387 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5388 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5389 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005390
5391 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5392 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005393 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5394 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5395 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5396 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005397 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5398
5399 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5400 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5401 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5402 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5403
5404 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5405 informational message reported in logs if an error
5406 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5407 log-format string.
5408
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005409 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005410 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5411 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005412 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5413 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5414 details on the supported keywords.
5415
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005416 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5417 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5418 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5419 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005420
5421 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5422 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5423 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5424 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5425 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5426
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005427 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5428 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5429 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5430 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5431 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5432 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5433 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005434
5435 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005436 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005437 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5438 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5439 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5440 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5441
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005442 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5443 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005444 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5445 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5446 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5447 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5448 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5449 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5450 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5451 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005452 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5453 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5454 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5455 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5456 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5457 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5458 insensitive on the header names.
5459
5460 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5461 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5462 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5463 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5464 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5465 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005466
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005467 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005468 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005469 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5470 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5471 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5472 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5473 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005474 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005475 trace).
5476
5477 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005478 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005479 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5480 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5481 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5482 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5483 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005484 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005485
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005486 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5487 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5488 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5489 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5490 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5491 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5492
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005493 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005494 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005495 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5496 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5497 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5498 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5499 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5500 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5501
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005502 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5503 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5504 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5505 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5506 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005507
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005508 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5509 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5510
5511 Examples :
5512 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005513 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005515 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5516 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5517
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005518 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005519 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005520
5521 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005522 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005523
5524 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005525 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005526
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005527 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005529
5530
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005531http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005532 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5533 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005534 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5535 health checks.
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5537 yes | no | yes | yes
5538 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005539 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5540
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005541 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5542 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5543 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5544 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5545 to invent non-standard ones.
5546
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005547 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5548 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5549 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5550 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5551
5552 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5553 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5554 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5555 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005556
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005557 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005558 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005559 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005560 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5561 to add it.
5562
5563 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5564 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5565 to the log-format rules.
5566
5567 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5568 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5569 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005570
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005571 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5572 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5573 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5574 request.
5575
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005576 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5577 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5578 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005579 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5580 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5581 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5582 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005583 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005584
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005586 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5587 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005588
5589 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5590 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5591 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5592 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5593 configured request authority.
5594
5595 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5596 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005598 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005599
5600
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005601http-check send-state
5602 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | no | yes | yes
5605 Arguments : none
5606
5607 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5608 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5609 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5610 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5611 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5612
5613 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5614 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5615 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5616 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5617 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005618 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5619 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5620 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5621
5622 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5623 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5624 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5625
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005626 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5627 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5628 checked in multiple backends.
5629
5630 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5631 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5632
5633 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5634 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5635 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5636 one fails.
5637
5638 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5639 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5640 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5641
5642 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5643 server's queue.
5644
5645 Example of a header received by the application server :
5646 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5647 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5648
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005649 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5650 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005651
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005652
5653http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005654 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 yes | no | yes | yes
5657
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005658 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005659 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5660 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5663 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5665 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5666 and '-'.
5667
5668 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5669
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005670 Examples :
5671 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005672
5673
5674http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005675 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | no | yes | yes
5678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005679 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005680 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5681 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5684 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5685 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5686 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5687 and '-'.
5688
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005689 Examples :
5690 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005693http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5694 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5695 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5696 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5697 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 yes | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005701 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005702 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005703 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005704 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005705
5706 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5707 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5708 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5709 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5710
5711 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5712 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5713 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5714 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5715
5716 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5717 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5718 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5719 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5720 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5721 chroot is performed.
5722
5723 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5724 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5725 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5726 considered.
5727
5728 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5729 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5730 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5731 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5732 considered as a raw string.
5733
5734 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5735 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5736 "content-type".
5737
5738 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5739 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5740 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5741 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5742 evaluated as a log-format string.
5743
5744 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5745 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5746 argument to "content-type".
5747
5748 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5749 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5750 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5751 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5752
5753 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5754 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5755 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5756 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5757 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5758 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5759 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5760 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5761
5762 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5763 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5764 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5765
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005766 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5767 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5768 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5769 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5770 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5771
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005772 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5773 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5774
5775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005776http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005777 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5778
5779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5780 no | yes | yes | yes
5781
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005782 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5783 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5784 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5785 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5786 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005788 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5789 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793 Example:
5794 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5795 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5796 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005798 http-request allow if nagios
5799 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5800 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5801 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803 Example:
5804 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5805 acl add path /addacl
5806 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005808 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5811 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 Example:
5814 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5815 acl setmap path /setmap
5816 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005818 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5821 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5824 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005826http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5829 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5830 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5831 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5832 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5833 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5834 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5835 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005837http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5840 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5841 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5842 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5843 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5844 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5845 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5846 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5851 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005852
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005854http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005856 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5857 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5858 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5859 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5860 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005861
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005862 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5863 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5864 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5865 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5866 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5867 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5868 instead.
5869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870 Example:
5871 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5872 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005873
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005874http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005875
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005876 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005881 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5882 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5883 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5884 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5885 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5886 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5887 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5888 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5889 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5892 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5893 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005894 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5895
5896 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5897 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5898 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5899 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005901http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5904 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5905 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5906 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5907 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5908 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005909
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005910http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005911
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005912 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5913 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5914 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5915 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5916 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005918http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5921 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5922 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5923 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5924 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5925 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005926
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005927http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5928http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5929 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5930 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5931 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5932 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005933
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005934 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5935 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5936 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005937 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005938 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5939 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5940 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005942 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005943
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005944http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5945 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5946 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5947 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5948
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005949http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5950
5951 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5952 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5953 pointed by <resolvers>.
5954 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5955 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5956 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5957 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5958 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5959 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5960 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5961 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5962 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5963 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5964 to 0.0.0.0.
5965
5966 Example:
5967 resolvers mydns
5968 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5969 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5970 timeout retry 1s
5971 hold valid 10s
5972 hold nx 3s
5973 hold other 3s
5974 hold obsolete 0s
5975 accepted_payload_size 8192
5976
5977 frontend fe
5978 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5979 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5980 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5981
5982 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5983 # which mean DNS resolution error
5984 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5985
5986 default_backend be
5987
5988 backend b_503
5989 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5990 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5991 # 503 error page to end users
5992
5993 backend be
5994 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5995 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5996 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5997 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5998 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5999
6000 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6001 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6002
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006003http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6004
6005 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6006 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6007 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6008 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006009 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6010 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006011
6012 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6013
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006014http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006015http-request normalize-uri dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006016http-request normalize-uri merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6017
6018 Performs normalization of the request's URI. The following normalizers are
6019 available:
6020
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006021 - dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component. This merges
6022 segments that attempt to access the parent directory with their preceding
6023 segment. Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the
6024 "merge-slashes" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6025
6026 Example:
6027 - /foo/../ -> /
6028 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6029 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6030 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006031 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006032 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
6033
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006034 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6035 removed as well:
6036
6037 Example:
6038 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6039 - /bar/../../ -> /
6040
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006041 - merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component into a
6042 single slash.
6043
6044 Example:
6045 - // -> /
6046 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6051 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6052 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6053 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6054 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006058 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6059 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6060 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6061 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006063http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6064 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006065
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006066 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006067 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6068 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6069 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6070 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6071 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006072
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006073 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6074 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6075 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6076 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6077 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006078
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006079 Example:
6080 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6081
6082 # applied to:
6083 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6084
6085 # outputs:
6086 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6087
6088 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006089
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006090 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6091
6092 # applied to:
6093 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006094
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006095 # outputs:
6096 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006097
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006098http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6100
6101 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6102 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006103 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6104 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6105 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006106
6107 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6108 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6109 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6110
6111 Example:
6112 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6113 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6114
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006115 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6116 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6117 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6118 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6119
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006120http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6121 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6122
6123 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6124 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6125 query-string are replaced.
6126
6127 Example:
6128 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6129 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6130
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006131http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6132 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6133
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006134 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6135 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6136 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6137 against.
6138
6139 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6140 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6141 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006142
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006143 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6144 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6145 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6146 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6147 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6148 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6149 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6150 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6151 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006152 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6153 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006154
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006155 Example:
6156 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6157 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006158
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006159 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6160 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006162http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6163 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006164
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006165 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6166 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6167 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6168 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006169
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006170 Example:
6171 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006172
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006173 # applied to:
6174 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006175
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006176 # outputs:
6177 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006178
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006179http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6180 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6181 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006182 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006183 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6184
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006185 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006186 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6187 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006188 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006189 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006190 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006191 are followed to create the response :
6192
6193 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6194 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6195 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6196 ignored.
6197
6198 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6199 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006200 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006201 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6202 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006203
6204 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6205 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6206 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006207 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6208 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006209
6210 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6211 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6212 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006213 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006214 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006215 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006216
6217 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6218 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6219 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6220 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6221 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6222 as a raw content.
6223
6224 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6225 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6226 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6227 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6228 considered as a raw string.
6229
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006230 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006231 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6232 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6233 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6234
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006235 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6236 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006237 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006238
6239 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6240
6241 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006242 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006243 if { path /ping }
6244
6245 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6246 if { path /favicon.ico }
6247
6248 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6249 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6250 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006252http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6253http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006255 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6256 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6257 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006258
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006259http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6260 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006261
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006262 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6263 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6264 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6265 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006268
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006269 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6270 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6271 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6272 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6273 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006275 Arguments:
6276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6277 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006279 Example:
6280 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6281 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006283 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6284 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006286http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006288 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6289 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6290 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006292 Arguments:
6293 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6294 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006296 Example:
6297 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6298 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006300 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6301 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6302 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006304http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006306 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6307 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6308 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6309 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6310 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006311
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006312 Example:
6313 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6314 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6315 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6316 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6317 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6318 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6319 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6320 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6321 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006323http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006325 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6326 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6327 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6328 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6329 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006331http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6332 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006334 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6335 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6336 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6337 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6338 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6339 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6340 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6341 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6342 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006344http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006346 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6347 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6348 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6349 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6350 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6351 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6352 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006354http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6357 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6358 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006360http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006361
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006362 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6363 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6364 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6365 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6366 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6367 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6368 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6369 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006371http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006373 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6374 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6375 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6376 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6377 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6378 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006379
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006380 Example :
6381 # prepend the host name before the path
6382 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006383
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006384http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6385
6386 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6387 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6388 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006390http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006392 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6393 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6394 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6395 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6396 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006398http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006400 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6401 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6402 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6403 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6404 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6405 values have higher priority.
6406 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6407 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6408 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6409 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6410 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006412http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006414 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6415 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6416 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6417 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6418 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6419 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6420 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006422 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006423
6424 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006425 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6426 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006428http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6429 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6430 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6431 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006432 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6433 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006434
6435 Arguments :
6436 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6437 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006438
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006439 See also "option forwardfor".
6440
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006441 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006442 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6443 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6444
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006445 # After the masking this will track connections
6446 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6447 http-request track-sc0 src
6448
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006449 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6450 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6451
6452http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6453
6454 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6455 expression.
6456
6457 Arguments:
6458 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6459 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006460
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006461 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006462 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6463 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6464
6465 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6466 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6467 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6468
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006469http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6470 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6471
6472 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6473 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6474 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6475 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6476 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6477
6478 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6479 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6480 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6481 results.
6482
6483 Example:
6484 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6485 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006487http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6488
6489 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6490 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6491 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6492 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6493 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6494 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6495 information from the request.
6496
6497 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6498
6499http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6500
6501 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6502 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6503 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6504 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6505 path and the query string.
6506 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6507
6508http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6509
6510 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6511 inline.
6512
6513 Arguments:
6514 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6515 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6516 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6517 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6518 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6519 (request and response)
6520 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6521 processing
6522 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6523 processing
6524 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6525 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6526 and '_'.
6527
6528 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6529 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006530
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006531 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006532 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006534http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6535 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006536
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006537 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6538 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6539 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6540 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6541 agent name must be used.
6542
6543 Arguments:
6544 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6545
6546 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6547 configuration.
6548
6549http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6550
6551 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6552 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6553 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6554 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6555 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6556 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6557 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6558 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6559 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6560 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6561 action.
6562 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6563 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6564 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6565 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6566 you fully understand how it works.
6567
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006568http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6569
6570 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6571 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6572 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6573 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6574 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006575 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006576 processing.
6577
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006578 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006579 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6580 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6581 rules evaluation.
6582
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006583http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6584http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6585 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6586 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6587 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589
6590 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6591 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6592 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006593 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6594 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6595 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6596 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6597 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6598 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6599 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6600 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6601 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6602 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006603 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006604 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6605 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6606 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6607 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6608 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006609
6610http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6611http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6612http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6613
6614 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6615 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6616 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6617 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006618 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006619 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6620 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6621 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6622 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6623 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6624 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6625 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6626
6627 Arguments :
6628 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6629 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6630 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6631 select which table entry to update the counters.
6632
6633 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6634 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6635 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6636 that table until the session ends.
6637
6638 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6639 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6640 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6641 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6642 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6643 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6644 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6645 useful information.
6646
6647 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6648 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6649 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6650 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6651 checks that make use of it.
6652
6653http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6654
6655 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006656
6657 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006658 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006659
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006660http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6661
6662 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6663 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6664 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6665 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6666 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6667 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6668
6669 Arguments :
6670 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6671
6672 Example:
6673 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6674
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006675http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6676 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6677
6678 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6679 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6680 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6681 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6682 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6683 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6684 http-buffer-request".
6685
6686 Arguments :
6687
6688 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6689 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6690
6691 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
6692 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
6693 bytes.
6694
6695 Example:
6696 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6697
6698 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006702 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6703 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6704 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006705
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006706
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006707http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006708 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6709
6710 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6711 no | yes | yes | yes
6712
6713 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6714 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6715 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6716 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6717 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6718 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006720 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6721 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006723 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006725 Example:
6726 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006728 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006730 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6731 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006732
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006733 Example:
6734 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006735
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006736 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006738 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6739 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006740
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006741 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6742 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006743
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006744http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006745
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006746 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6747 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6748 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6749 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6750 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6751 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6752 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6753 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006754
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006755http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006757 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6758 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6759 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6760 example, or to pass some internal information.
6761 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6762 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6763 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006765http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006766
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006767 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6768 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006769
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006770http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006771
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006772 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006773
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006774http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006776 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6777 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6778 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6779 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6780 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6781 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6782 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006783
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006784 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6785 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6786 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6787 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6788 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006789
6790 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6791 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6792 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6793 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006795http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006797 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6798 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6799 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6800 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6801 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6802 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006803
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006804http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006805
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006806 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6807 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6808 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6809 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6810 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006811
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006812http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006813
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006814 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6815 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6816 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6817 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6818 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6819 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006820
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006821http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6822http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6823 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6824 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6825 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6826 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006827
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006828 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6829 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6830 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006831 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006832 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6833 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6834 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006835 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006836 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006837
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006838http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006840 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6841 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6842 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6843 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6844 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6845 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006846
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006847http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6848 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006849
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006850 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6851 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006852
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006853 Example:
6854 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006856 # applied to:
6857 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006859 # outputs:
6860 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006862 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006863
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006864http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6865 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006866
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006867 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006868 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006870 Example:
6871 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006873 # applied to:
6874 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006875
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006876 # outputs:
6877 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006878
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006879http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6880 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6881 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006882 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006883 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6884
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006885 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006886 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6887 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006888 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006889 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006890 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006891 are followed to create the response :
6892
6893 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6894 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6895 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6896 ignored.
6897
6898 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6899 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006900 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006901 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6902 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006903
6904 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6905 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6906 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006907 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6908 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006909
6910 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6911 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6912 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006913 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006914 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006915 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006916
6917 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6918 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6919 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6920 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6921 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6922 as a raw content.
6923
6924 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6925 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6926 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6927 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6928 considered as a raw string.
6929
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006930 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6931 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6932 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6933 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6934
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006935 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6936 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006937 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006938
6939 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6940
6941 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006942 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006943 if { status eq 404 }
6944
6945 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6946 string "This is the end !" \
6947 if { status eq 500 }
6948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006949http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6950http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006951
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006952 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6953 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6954 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006955
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006956http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6957 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006958
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006959 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6960 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6961 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6962 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006964http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006966 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6967 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6968 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6969 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6970 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006972 Arguments:
6973 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006975 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6976 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006978http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006979
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006980 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6981 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6982 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006984http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6985
6986 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6987 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6988 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6989 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6990 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6991
6992http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6993
6994 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6995 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6996 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6997 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6998 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6999 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7000 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7001 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7002 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7003
7004http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7005
7006 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7007 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7008 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7009 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7010 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7011 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7012 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7013
7014http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7015
7016 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7017 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7018 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7019 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7020 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7021 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7022 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7023 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7024
7025http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7026 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7027
7028 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7029 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7030 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7031 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007032
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007033 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007034 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7035 http-response set-status 431
7036 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7037 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007039http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7042 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7043 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7044 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7045 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7046 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7047 based on some information from the request.
7048
7049 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7050
7051http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7052
7053 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7054 inline.
7055
7056 Arguments:
7057 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7058 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7059 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7060 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7061 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7062 (request and response)
7063 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7064 processing
7065 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7066 processing
7067 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7068 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7069 and '_'.
7070
7071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7072 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007073
7074 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007079 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7080 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7081 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7082 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7083 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7084 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7085 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7086 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7087 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7088 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7089 action.
7090 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7091 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7092 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7093 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7094 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007095
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007096http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7097
7098 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7099 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7100 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7101 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7102 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007103 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007104 processing.
7105
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007106 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007107 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007108 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007109 rules evaluation.
7110
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007111http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7112http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7113http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007115 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7116 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7117 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7118 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7119 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7120 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7121
7122http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7123
7124 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7125 about <var-name>.
7126
7127 Example:
7128 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7129
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007130http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7131 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7132
7133 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7134 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7135 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7136 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7137 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7138 buffer is full.
7139
7140 Arguments :
7141
7142 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7143 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7144
7145 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
7146 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7147 bytes.
7148
7149 Example:
7150 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007151
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007152http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7153 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7154
7155 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7156 yes | no | yes | yes
7157
7158 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007159 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7160 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7161 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007162
7163 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7164
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007165 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7166 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7167 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7168 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7169 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7170 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7171 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7172 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7173 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7174 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007175
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007176 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7177 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7178 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7179 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7180 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7181 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7182 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007183 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7184 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7185 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7186 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7187 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7188 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007189
7190 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7191 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7192 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7193 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7194 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7195 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7196 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7197 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007198 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007199 downsides of rare connection failures.
7200
7201 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7202 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7203 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7204 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7205 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7206 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007207 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007208 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7209 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7210 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7211 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7212 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7213
7214 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007215 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7216 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7217 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7218 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007219
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007220 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7221 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007222
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007223 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007224
7225 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7226 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7227 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7228
7229 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7230
7231
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007232http-send-name-header [<header>]
7233 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7235 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007236 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007237 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7238
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007239 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7240 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7241 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7242 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7243 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7244 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7245 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7246 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7247 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7248 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7249 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7250 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7251 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7252 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7253 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7254 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007255
7256 See also : "server"
7257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007258id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007259 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7261 no | yes | yes | yes
7262 Arguments : none
7263
7264 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7265 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7266 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007267
7268
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007269ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7270 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007272 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007273
7274 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7275 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7276 and running).
7277
7278 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7279 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7280 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007281 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007282 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7283
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007284 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7285 "unless" condition is met.
7286
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007287 Example:
7288 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7289 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7290 ignore-persist if url_static
7291
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007292 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7293
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007294load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7295 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7297 yes | no | yes | yes
7298
7299 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7300 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7301 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007302 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007303 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7304 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7305 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7306 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7307
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007308 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007309 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007310 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007311
7312 Arguments:
7313 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7314 named "server-state-file".
7315
7316 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7317 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7318 name is used as a file name.
7319
7320 none don't load any stat for this backend
7321
7322 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007323 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7324 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7325 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007326 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007327 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007328
7329 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7330 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7331
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007332 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007333
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007334 global
7335 stats socket /tmp/socket
7336 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007337
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007338 defaults
7339 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007341 backend bk
7342 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7343 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007344
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007345
7346 Then one can run :
7347
7348 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7349
7350 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7351
7352 1
7353 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7354 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7355 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7356
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007357 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007358
7359 global
7360 stats socket /tmp/socket
7361 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7362
7363 defaults
7364 load-server-state-from-file local
7365
7366 backend bk
7367 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7368 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7369
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007370
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007371 Then one can run :
7372
7373 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7374
7375 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7376
7377 1
7378 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7379 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7380 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7381
7382 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7383 "show servers state"
7384
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007385
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007386log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007387log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007388 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007389no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007390 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007393
7394 Prefix :
7395 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7396 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7397 prefix does not allow arguments.
7398
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007399 Arguments :
7400 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7401 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7402 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7403 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7404 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7405 parameter.
7406
7407 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7408 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7409
7410 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7411 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7412 standard syslog port).
7413
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007414 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7415 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7416 standard syslog port).
7417
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007418 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7419 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7420 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007421 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007422
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007423 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7424 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7425 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7426 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7427 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7428 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7429 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7430 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7431 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7432 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7433 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7434 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7435 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7436 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7437 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7438 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007439 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7440 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007441
7442 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7443 and "fd@2", see above.
7444
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007445 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7446 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7447 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7448 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7449 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7450 having the logs instantly available.
7451
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007452 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7453 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7454 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7455
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007456 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7457 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007458
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007459 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7460 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7461 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7462 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7463 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7464 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7465 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7466 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7467 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7468 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007469 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007470
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007471 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7472 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7473 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7474 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7475 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7476
7477 <sample_size>
7478 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7479 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7480 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7481 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7482 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7483
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007484 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7485 one of the following :
7486
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007487 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7488 field is stripped. This is the default.
7489 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7490 rfc3164.
7491
7492 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007493 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7494
7495 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7496 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7497
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007498 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7499 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7500 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7501 designed to be used with a local log server.
7502
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007503 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7504 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7505 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7506 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7507 systemd logger consumes.
7508
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007509 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7510 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7511 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7512 used with a local log server.
7513
7514 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7515 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7516 designed to be used with a local log server.
7517
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007518 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7519 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7520 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7521 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007523 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7524
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007525 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7526 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7527 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7528
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007529 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7530 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7531 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7532 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007533
7534 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7535 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7536 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007537 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7538 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7539 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7540 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7541 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007542
7543 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7544
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007545 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7546 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7547 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007548
7549 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7550 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7551 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7552 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7553
7554 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7555 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007556
7557 Example :
7558 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007559 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7560 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7561 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007562 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007563 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7564 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007565 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007566
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007567
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007568log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007569 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7570 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7571 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007572
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007573 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7574 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7575 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7576 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7577 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007578
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007579 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7580 "option httplog" directives.
7581
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007582log-format-sd <string>
7583 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7584 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7585 yes | yes | yes | no
7586
7587 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7588 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7589 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7590 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7591 which covers the log format string in depth.
7592
7593 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7594 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7595
7596 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7597 log format to "rfc5424".
7598
7599 Example :
7600 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7601
7602
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007603log-tag <string>
7604 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | yes | yes | yes
7607
7608 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7609 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7610 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7611 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7612 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7613 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7614 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7615 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7616 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007617
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007618max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7619 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7621 yes | no | yes | yes
7622
7623 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7624 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7625 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7626 servers.
7627
7628 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7629 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7630 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7631 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7632 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007633 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007634 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7635 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7636 picking a different server.
7637
7638 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7639 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7640 even if they have to be queued.
7641
7642 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7643 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7644
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007645max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7646 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7647 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7648 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007649
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007650maxconn <conns>
7651 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 yes | yes | yes | no
7654 Arguments :
7655 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7656 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7657 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7658 closes.
7659
7660 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7661 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7662 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7663 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007664 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7665 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7666 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7667 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007668
7669 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7670 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7671 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7672
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007673 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7674 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007675
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007676 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7677
7678
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007679mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007680 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7682 yes | yes | yes | yes
7683 Arguments :
7684 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7685 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7686 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7687 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7688
7689 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7690 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7691 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7692 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7693 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7694
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007695 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7696 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7697 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007698
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007699 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007700 defaults http_instances
7701 mode http
7702
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007703
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007704monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007705 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007708 Arguments :
7709 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7710 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007711 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007712 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7713 backend and its backup.
7714
7715 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7716 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7717 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7718 servers in a list of backends.
7719
7720 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7721 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7722 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7723 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7724 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7725 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7726 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007727 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7728 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007729
7730 Example:
7731 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007732 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007733 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7734 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7735 monitor-uri /site_alive
7736 monitor fail if site_dead
7737
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007738 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007739
7740
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007741monitor-uri <uri>
7742 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7744 yes | yes | yes | no
7745 Arguments :
7746 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7747 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7748
7749 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7750 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7751 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7752 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7753 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7754 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7755 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7756 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7757
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007758 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007759 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7760 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7761 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7762 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7763 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7764 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007765
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007766 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7767 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7768 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7769 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7770
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007771 Example :
7772 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7773 frontend www
7774 mode http
7775 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7776
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007777 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007778
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007779
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007780option abortonclose
7781no option abortonclose
7782 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7784 yes | no | yes | yes
7785 Arguments : none
7786
7787 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7788 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7789 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7790 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007791 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007792 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7793 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7794 encountered while delivering the response.
7795
7796 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7797 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7798 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7799 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7800 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7801 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007802 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007803 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007804 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007805 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7806 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7807 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7808
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007809 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7810 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007811 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7812 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7813 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7814 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7815 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7816 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007817 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007818
7819 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7820 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7821
7822 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7823
7824
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007825option accept-invalid-http-request
7826no option accept-invalid-http-request
7827 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 yes | yes | yes | no
7830 Arguments : none
7831
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007832 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007833 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007834 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007835 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7836 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7837 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7838 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7839 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007840 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7841 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7842 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7843 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007844 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007845 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007846 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7847 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7848 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007849
7850 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7851 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7852 been confirmed.
7853
7854 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7855 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007856 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7857 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007858 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7859
7860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7862
7863 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7864 stats socket.
7865
7866
7867option accept-invalid-http-response
7868no option accept-invalid-http-response
7869 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7871 yes | no | yes | yes
7872 Arguments : none
7873
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007874 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007875 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007876 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007877 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7878 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7879 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7880 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7881 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007882 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7883 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7884 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007885
7886 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7887 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7888 been confirmed.
7889
7890 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7891 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7892 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7893 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7894
7895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7897
7898 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7899 stats socket.
7900
7901
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007902option allbackups
7903no option allbackups
7904 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7906 yes | no | yes | yes
7907 Arguments : none
7908
7909 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7910 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7911 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7912 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7913 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7914 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7915 order between the backup servers anymore.
7916
7917 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7918 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7919
7920 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7921 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7922
7923
7924option checkcache
7925no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007926 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7928 yes | no | yes | yes
7929 Arguments : none
7930
7931 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7932 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007933 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007934 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7935 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007936 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007937
7938 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007939 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007940 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007941 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7942 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007943 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007944 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007945 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7946 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007947 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007948 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7949 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007950 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007951 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7952 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7953 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7954 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7955 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7956 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7957 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7958 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7959 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7960
7961 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007962 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7963 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7964 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7965 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007966
7967 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7968 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007969 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007970 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007971
7972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7974
7975
7976option clitcpka
7977no option clitcpka
7978 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7980 yes | yes | yes | no
7981 Arguments : none
7982
7983 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7984 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007985 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007986 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7987
7988 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7989 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7990 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7991 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7992
7993 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7994 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7995 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7996 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7997 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7998
7999 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8000
8001 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8002 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8003 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8004
8005 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8006 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8007
8008 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8009
8010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008011option contstats
8012 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8014 yes | yes | yes | no
8015 Arguments : none
8016
8017 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8018 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8019 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8020 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008021 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8022 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8023 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8024 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8025 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008026
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008027option disable-h2-upgrade
8028no option disable-h2-upgrade
8029 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8030 connection.
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8032 yes | yes | yes | no
8033 Arguments : none
8034
8035 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8036 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8037 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8038 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008039 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8040 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8041 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8042 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8043 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8044 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008045
8046 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8047 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008048
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008049option dontlog-normal
8050no option dontlog-normal
8051 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | yes | yes | no
8054 Arguments : none
8055
8056 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8057 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8058 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8059 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8060 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8061 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8062 logged.
8063
8064 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8065 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8066 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008068 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008069 logging.
8070
8071
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008072option dontlognull
8073no option dontlognull
8074 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8076 yes | yes | yes | no
8077 Arguments : none
8078
8079 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8080 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8081 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8082 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8083 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8084 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008085 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8086 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8087 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008088
8089 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008090 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008091 would not be logged.
8092
8093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8095
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008096 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008097 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008098
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008099
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008100option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008101 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8103 yes | yes | yes | yes
8104 Arguments :
8105 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8106 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008107 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008108 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008109
8110 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8111 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8112 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8113 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8114 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8115 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8116 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008117 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8118 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8119 possible that the client has already brought one.
8120
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008121 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008122 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008123 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008124 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008125 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008126 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008127
8128 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8129 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8130 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8131 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8132 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8133 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008134 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008135
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008136 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8137 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8138 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8139 are under the control of the end-user.
8140
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008141 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008142 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8143 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008144 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8145 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8146 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008147
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008148 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008149 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8150 frontend www
8151 mode http
8152 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8153
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008154 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8155 backend www
8156 mode http
8157 option forwardfor header X-Client
8158
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008159 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008160 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008161
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008162
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008163option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8164no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8165 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8167 yes | yes | yes | no
8168 Arguments : none
8169
8170 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8171 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8172 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8173 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8174 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8175 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8176 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8177
8178 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8179 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8180 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8181 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8182 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8183 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8184 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8185 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8186 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8187 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8188
8189 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8190
8191 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8192 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8193
8194 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8195 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8196
8197
8198option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8199no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8200 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8202 yes | no | yes | yes
8203 Arguments : none
8204
8205 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8206 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8207 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8208 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8209 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8210 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8211 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8212
8213 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8214 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8215 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8216 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8217 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8218 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8219 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8220 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8221 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8222 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8223
8224 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8225
8226 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8227 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8228
8229 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8230 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8231
8232
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008233option http-buffer-request
8234no option http-buffer-request
8235 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8237 yes | yes | yes | yes
8238 Arguments : none
8239
8240 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8241 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8242 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8243 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8244 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8245 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008246 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8247 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8248 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8249 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008250
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008251 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8252 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008253
8254
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008255option http-ignore-probes
8256no option http-ignore-probes
8257 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8259 yes | yes | yes | no
8260 Arguments : none
8261
8262 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8263 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8264 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8265 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8266 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8267 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8268 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8269 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8270 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008271 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8272 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008273 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8274
8275 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8276 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8277 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8278 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8279 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8280 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8281 are often the only way to detect them.
8282
8283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8285
8286 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8287
8288
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008289option http-keep-alive
8290no option http-keep-alive
8291 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8293 yes | yes | yes | yes
8294 Arguments : none
8295
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008296 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8297 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008298 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8299 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008300 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8301 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8302 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008303
8304 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8305 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008306 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8307 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8308 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8309 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8310 situations where this option may be useful :
8311
8312 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008313 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008314
8315 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8316 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8317
8318 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8319 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8320 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8321 request.
8322
8323 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8324 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008325 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8326 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8327 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008328
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008329 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8330 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8331 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8332 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8333 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8334 not set.
8335
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008336 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8337 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8338 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008339
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008340 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008341 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008342 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008343
8344
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008345option http-no-delay
8346no option http-no-delay
8347 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8349 yes | yes | yes | yes
8350 Arguments : none
8351
8352 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8353 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8354 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8355 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8356 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8357 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8358 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8359 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8360 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8361 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8362 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8363 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8364 affected.
8365
8366 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8367 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8368 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8369 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8370 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8371 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8372 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8373 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8374 latency environments.
8375
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008376 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8377
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008378
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008379option http-pretend-keepalive
8380no option http-pretend-keepalive
8381 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008383 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008384 Arguments : none
8385
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008386 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008387 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8388 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8389 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8390 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8391 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8392 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8393 consider the response complete.
8394
8395 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8396 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8397 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8398 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008399 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008400 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8401
8402 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8403 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8404 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8405 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8406 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8407 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8408 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8409
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008410 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8411 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8412 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8413 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8414 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8415 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008416
8417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8419
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008420 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008421 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008422
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008423
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008424option http-server-close
8425no option http-server-close
8426 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8428 yes | yes | yes | yes
8429 Arguments : none
8430
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008431 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8432 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8433 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8434 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008435 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8436 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8437 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8438 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8439 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8440 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8441 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8442 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8443 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8444 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8445 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008446
8447 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8448 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8449 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8450 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008451 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8452 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008453
8454 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8455 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008456 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8457 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8458 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008459
8460 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8461 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8462
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008463 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8464 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008465
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008466option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008467no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008468 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8470 yes | yes | yes | no
8471 Arguments : none
8472
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008473 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008474 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8475 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8476 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8477 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8478 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8479 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8480
8481 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8482 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008483 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8484 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8485 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008486
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008487 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8488 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8489 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8490 front of an existing proxy.
8491
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008492 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8493
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008494 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008495
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008496option httpchk
8497option httpchk <uri>
8498option httpchk <method> <uri>
8499option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008500 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8502 yes | no | yes | yes
8503 Arguments :
8504 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8505 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8506 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8507 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8508 ones.
8509
8510 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8511 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8512 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8513
8514 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8515 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8516 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008517 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008518
8519 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8520 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8521 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8522 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8523 the lack of any response.
8524
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008525 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8526 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8527 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8528 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8529
8530 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8531 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8532 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008533
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008534 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8535 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008536 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008537 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008538 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008539
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008540 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8541 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8542 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8543 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8544
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008545 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008546 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8547 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8548 backend https_relay
8549 mode tcp
8550 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8551 http-check send hdr Host www
8552 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008553
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008554 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8555 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8556 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008557
8558
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008559option httpclose
8560no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008561 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8563 yes | yes | yes | yes
8564 Arguments : none
8565
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008566 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8567 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8568 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8569 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008570 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008571
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008572 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8573 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008574 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008575 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8576 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008577
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008578 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8579 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8580 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008581
8582 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8583 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008584 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8585 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8586 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008587
8588 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8589 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8590
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008591 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008592
8593
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008594option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008595 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008597 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008598 Arguments :
8599 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8600 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8601 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008602 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008603 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008604
8605 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8606 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8607 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8608 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8609 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8610 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8611 ports.
8612
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008613 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8614 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008615
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008616 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008618 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008619
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008620
8621option http_proxy
8622no option http_proxy
8623 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8625 yes | yes | yes | yes
8626 Arguments : none
8627
8628 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8629 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8630 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8631 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8632 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8633
8634 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8635 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008636 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8637 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008638
8639 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8640 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8641
8642 Example :
8643 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8644 backend direct_forward
8645 option httpclose
8646 option http_proxy
8647
8648 See also : "option httpclose"
8649
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008650
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008651option independent-streams
8652no option independent-streams
8653 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8655 yes | yes | yes | yes
8656 Arguments : none
8657
8658 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8659 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8660 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8661 receive data or not.
8662
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008663 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008664 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8665 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8666 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8667 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8668 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8669 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8670 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8671 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8672 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8673 socket buffers.
8674
8675 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8676 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8677 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8678 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8679 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8680
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008681 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008682
8683
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008684option ldap-check
8685 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8687 yes | no | yes | yes
8688 Arguments : none
8689
8690 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8691 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8692 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8693 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8694
8695 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8696 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8697
8698 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8699 configure it.
8700
8701 Example :
8702 option ldap-check
8703
8704 See also : "option httpchk"
8705
8706
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008707option external-check
8708 Use external processes for server health checks
8709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8710 yes | no | yes | yes
8711
8712 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8713 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8714 command".
8715
8716 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8717
8718 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8719
8720
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008721option log-health-checks
8722no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008723 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8725 yes | no | yes | yes
8726 Arguments : none
8727
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008728 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8729 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8730 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008731
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008732 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8733 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8734 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8735 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8736 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8737
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008738 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008739 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008740
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008741 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8742 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8743 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008744
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008745
8746option log-separate-errors
8747no option log-separate-errors
8748 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8750 yes | yes | yes | no
8751 Arguments : none
8752
8753 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8754 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8755 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8756 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8757 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8758 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8759 provides very important information.
8760
8761 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8762 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8763 error logs.
8764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008765 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008766 logging.
8767
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008768
8769option logasap
8770no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008771 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8773 yes | yes | yes | no
8774 Arguments : none
8775
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008776 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8777 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8778 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8779 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8780
8781 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8782 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8783 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8784 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8785 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008786 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008787 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8788 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8789 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8790 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008791 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008792
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008793 Examples :
8794 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8795 mode http
8796 option httplog
8797 option logasap
8798 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8799
8800 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8801 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8802 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8803 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008805 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008806 logging.
8807
8808
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008809option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008810 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8812 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008813 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008814 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8815 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008816 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8817 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008818
8819 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8820 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008821 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008822 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8823 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8824 in the MySQL table, like this :
8825
8826 USE mysql;
8827 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8828 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8829
8830 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008832 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8833 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8834 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8835 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8836 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8837 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8838 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8839
8840 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8841 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008842
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008843 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008844
8845 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8846 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8847 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8848 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008849 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8850 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008851
8852 See also: "option httpchk"
8853
8854
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008855option nolinger
8856no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008857 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008858 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8859 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008860 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008861
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008862 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008863 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8864 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8865 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8866 connections.
8867
8868 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8869 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008870 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8871 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8872 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8873 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8874 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8875 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8876 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8877 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8878 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8879 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8880 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8881 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8882 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008883
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008884 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8885 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8886 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8887 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8888 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008889
8890 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8891 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008892 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008893 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008894 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008895
8896 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8897 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8898
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008899 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8900 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008901
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008902option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8903 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8905 yes | yes | yes | yes
8906 Arguments :
8907 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8908 matching <network>
8909 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8910 header name.
8911
8912 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8913 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8914 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8915 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8916 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8917 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8918 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8919 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8920 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8921 possible that the client has already brought one.
8922
8923 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8924 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8925 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8926 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8927 header and requires different one.
8928
8929 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8930 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8931 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01008932 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
8933 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
8934 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
8935 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
8936 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008937
8938 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8939 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8940 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8941 both are defined.
8942
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008943 Examples :
8944 # Original Destination address
8945 frontend www
8946 mode http
8947 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8948
8949 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8950 backend www
8951 mode http
8952 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8953
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008954 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008955
8956
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008957option persist
8958no option persist
8959 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8961 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008962 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008963
8964 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8965 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8966 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8967 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8968 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8969 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8970 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8971 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8972 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8973 redirected to another valid server.
8974
8975 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8976 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8977
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008978 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008979
8980
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008981option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8982 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8984 yes | no | yes | yes
8985 Arguments :
8986 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8987 PostgreSQL server.
8988
8989 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8990 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8991 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8992 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8993
8994 See also: "option httpchk"
8995
8996
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008997option prefer-last-server
8998no option prefer-last-server
8999 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9000 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9001 yes | no | yes | yes
9002 Arguments : none
9003
9004 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9005 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9006 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9007 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9008 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9009 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9010 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9011 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9012 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009013 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9014 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009015 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9016 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9017 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009018 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9019 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9020 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009021
9022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9024
9025 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9026
9027
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009028option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009029option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009030no option redispatch
9031 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9033 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009034 Arguments :
9035 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9036 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9037 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009038 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009039 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009040 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009041 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9042 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9043 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009045
9046 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9047 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9048 be able to access the service anymore.
9049
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009050 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9051 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009052
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009053 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9054 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9055 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9056 following order:
9057
9058 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9059
9060 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9061 list, or
9062
9063 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9064
9065 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9066 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9067
9068 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9069 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9070 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9071 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9072
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009073 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009074 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9075 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009076
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9079
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009080 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009081
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009082
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009083option redis-check
9084 Use redis health checks for server testing
9085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9086 yes | no | yes | yes
9087 Arguments : none
9088
9089 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9090 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9091 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9092 find the "+PONG" response message.
9093
9094 Example :
9095 option redis-check
9096
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009097 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009098
9099
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009100option smtpchk
9101option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9102 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9104 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009105 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009106 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009107 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009108 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9109
9110 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9111 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9112 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9113
9114 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9115 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9116 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9117 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9118 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9119 dead server.
9120
9121 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9122 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009123 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009124 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9125
9126 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9127 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9128 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9129 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009130 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009131
9132 Example :
9133 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9134
9135 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009138option socket-stats
9139no option socket-stats
9140
9141 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9143 yes | yes | yes | no
9144
9145 Arguments : none
9146
9147
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009148option splice-auto
9149no option splice-auto
9150 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9152 yes | yes | yes | yes
9153 Arguments : none
9154
9155 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9156 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009157 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009158 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009159 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009160 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9161 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9162 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9163 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9164
9165 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9166 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9167 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9168 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9169 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9170 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9171 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9172 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9173 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9174 keyword.
9175
9176 Example :
9177 option splice-auto
9178
9179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9181
9182 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9183 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9184
9185
9186option splice-request
9187no option splice-request
9188 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9190 yes | yes | yes | yes
9191 Arguments : none
9192
9193 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009194 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009195 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9196 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9197 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9198 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9199
9200 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9201
9202 Example :
9203 option splice-request
9204
9205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9207
9208 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9209 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9210
9211
9212option splice-response
9213no option splice-response
9214 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9216 yes | yes | yes | yes
9217 Arguments : none
9218
9219 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009220 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009221 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9222 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9223 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9224 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9225
9226 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9227
9228 Example :
9229 option splice-response
9230
9231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9233
9234 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9235 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9236
9237
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009238option spop-check
9239 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9241 no | no | no | yes
9242 Arguments : none
9243
9244 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9245 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9246 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9247 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9248
9249 Example :
9250 option spop-check
9251
9252 See also : "option httpchk"
9253
9254
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009255option srvtcpka
9256no option srvtcpka
9257 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9259 yes | no | yes | yes
9260 Arguments : none
9261
9262 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9263 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009264 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009265 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9266
9267 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9268 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9269 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9270 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9271
9272 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9273 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9274 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9275 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9276 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9277
9278 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9279
9280 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9281 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9282 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9283
9284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9286
9287 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9288
9289
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009290option ssl-hello-chk
9291 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9293 yes | no | yes | yes
9294 Arguments : none
9295
9296 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9297 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9298 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9299 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9300 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9301 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9302 hello message.
9303
9304 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9305 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9306 messages, which is appreciable.
9307
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009308 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9309 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9310 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009311
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009312 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9313
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009314
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009315option tcp-check
9316 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9318 yes | no | yes | yes
9319
9320 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9321 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9322
9323 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9324 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9325 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9326
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009327 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009328 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9329 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9330 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9331 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9332 only.
9333
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009334 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009335 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9336 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9337 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9338 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9339
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009340 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009341 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9342 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009343 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009344 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9345 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9346 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9347 the respective protocols.
9348 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009349 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009350
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009351 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009352
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009353 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9354 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9355 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9356 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009357
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009358 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9359 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9360 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009361
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009362
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009363 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009364 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009365 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009366 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009368 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009369 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009370 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009371
9372 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9373 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009374 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009375 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009376 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009377 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009378 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009379 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009380 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9381 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009382 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009383 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9384 tcp-check expect string +OK
9385
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009386 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009387 (send many headers before analyzing)
9388 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009389 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009390 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9391 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9392 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9393 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009394 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009395
9396
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009397 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009398
9399
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009400option tcp-smart-accept
9401no option tcp-smart-accept
9402 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9404 yes | yes | yes | no
9405 Arguments : none
9406
9407 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9408 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9409 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9410 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9411 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9412 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9413
9414 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9415 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9416 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9417 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9418
9419 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9420 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9421 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009422 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009423
9424 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9425 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9426 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9427
9428 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9429 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9430 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9431
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009432 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9433
9434
9435option tcp-smart-connect
9436no option tcp-smart-connect
9437 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9439 yes | no | yes | yes
9440 Arguments : none
9441
9442 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9443 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9444 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9445 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9446 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9447
9448 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9449 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9450 complex.
9451
9452 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9453 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9454 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9455
9456 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9457 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9458
9459 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9460
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009461
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009462option tcpka
9463 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9465 yes | yes | yes | yes
9466 Arguments : none
9467
9468 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9469 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009470 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009471 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9472
9473 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9474 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9475 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9476 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9477
9478 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9479 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9480 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9481 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9482 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9483
9484 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9485
9486 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9487 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9488 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9489 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9490 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9491 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9492 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9493 backends.
9494
9495 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9496
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009497
9498option tcplog
9499 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009501 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009502 Arguments : none
9503
9504 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9505 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9506 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9507 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9508 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9509 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9510 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9511 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9512
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009513 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009515 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009516
9517
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009518option transparent
9519no option transparent
9520 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009522 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009523 Arguments : none
9524
9525 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9526 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9527 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9528 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9529 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9530 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9531 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9532 appropriate server.
9533
9534 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9535 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9536
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009537 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009538 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009539
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009540
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009541external-check command <command>
9542 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9544 yes | no | yes | yes
9545
9546 Arguments :
9547 <command> is the external command to run
9548
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009549 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9550
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009551 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009552
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009553 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9554 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9555 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9556 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9557 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9558 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009559
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009560 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9561
9562 Environment variables :
9563 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9564 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9565
9566 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9567
9568 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9569
9570 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9571 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9572 for a UNIX socket).
9573
9574 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9575
9576 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9577
9578 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9579
9580 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9581
9582 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9583
9584 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9585 socket).
9586
9587 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9588 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9589
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009590 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9591
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009592 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9593 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9594 failed.
9595
9596 Example :
9597 external-check command /bin/true
9598
9599 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9600
9601
9602external-check path <path>
9603 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9605 yes | no | yes | yes
9606
9607 Arguments :
9608 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9609
9610 The default path is "".
9611
9612 Example :
9613 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9614
9615 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9616 "external-check command"
9617
9618
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009619persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009620persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009621 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9623 yes | no | yes | yes
9624 Arguments :
9625 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009626 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9627 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009628
9629 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9630 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009631 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009632 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9633 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9634 forwarded to this server.
9635
9636 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9637 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9638 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009639 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009640 a single "listen" section.
9641
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009642 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9643 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9644 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9645
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009646 Example :
9647 listen tse-farm
9648 bind :3389
9649 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9650 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9651 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9652 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9653 persist rdp-cookie
9654 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009655 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009656 balance rdp-cookie
9657 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9658 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9659
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009660 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9661 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009662
9663
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009664rate-limit sessions <rate>
9665 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9667 yes | yes | yes | no
9668 Arguments :
9669 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9670 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9671
9672 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9673 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9674 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9675 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9676 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9677 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9678
9679 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9680 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9681 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9682 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9683
9684 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9685 listen smtp
9686 mode tcp
9687 bind :25
9688 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009689 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009690
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009691 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9692 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9693 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009694
9695 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9696
9697
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009698redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9699redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9700redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009701 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9703 no | yes | yes | yes
9704
9705 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009706 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009707
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009708 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009709 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009710 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9711 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9712 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009713
9714 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9715 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9716 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9717 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9718 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009719 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9720 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9721 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9722 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009723
9724 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9725 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9726 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9727 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9728 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9729 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009730 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009731 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009732 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9733 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9734 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009735
9736 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009737 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9738 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9739 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009740 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009741 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9742 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9743 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9744 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009745
9746 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009747 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009748
9749 - "drop-query"
9750 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9751 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9752 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9753 with a location-type redirect.
9754
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009755 - "append-slash"
9756 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9757 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9758 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9759 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9760
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009761 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9762 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9763 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9764 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9765 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9766 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9767 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9768
9769 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9770 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9771 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9772 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9773 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9774 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9775 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009776
9777 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9778 acl clear dst_port 80
9779 acl secure dst_port 8080
9780 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009781 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009782 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009783 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9784
9785 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009786 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9787 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9788 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009789 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009790
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009791 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9792 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9793 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9794
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009795 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009796 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009797
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009798 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009799 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9800 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9801 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009803 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009804
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009805
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009806retries <value>
9807 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9809 yes | no | yes | yes
9810 Arguments :
9811 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9812 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9813 default value is 3.
9814
9815 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9816 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9817 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9818
9819 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009820 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9821 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009822
9823 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9824 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9825
9826 See also : "option redispatch"
9827
9828
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009829retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009830 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9831 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9832 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9834 yes | no | yes | yes
9835 Arguments :
9836 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9837 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9838 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9839 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9840
9841 none never retry
9842
9843 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9844 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9845
9846 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9847 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9848 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9849 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9850 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9851 processing the request.
9852
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009853 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9854 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9855 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9856 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9857 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9858 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9859 overflow attack for example).
9860
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009861 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9862 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9863 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9864 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9865 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9866 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9867 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9868 amplify denial of service attacks.
9869
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009870 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9871 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9872 considered to be safe to retry.
9873
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009874 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9875 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9876 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9877 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9878 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009879
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009880 all-retryable-errors
9881 retry request for any error that are considered
9882 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9883 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9884 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9885
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009886 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9887 not cumulative.
9888
9889 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9890 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9891 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9892 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9893
9894 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9895 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9896 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9897 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9898 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9899 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9900 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9901 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9902 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9903 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9904 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9905 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9906
9907 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9908 should not use this directive.
9909
9910 The default is "conn-failure".
9911
9912 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9913
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009914server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009915 Declare a server in a backend
9916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9917 no | no | yes | yes
9918 Arguments :
9919 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009920 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009921 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009922
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009923 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9924 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9925 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9926 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009927 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9928 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9929 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9930 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9931 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009932 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9933 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9934 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9935 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9936 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9937 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9938 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009939 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009940 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9941 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9942 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9943 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9944 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9945 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009946 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9947 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009948 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9949 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009950
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009951 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009952 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9953 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9954 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9955 adding this value to the client's port.
9956
9957 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9958 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009959 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009960
9961 Examples :
9962 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9963 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009964 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009965 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9966 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9967 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009968
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009969 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9970 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9971 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9972 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9973 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9974
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009975 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9976 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009977
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009978server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009979 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009980 this backend.
9981 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9982 no | no | yes | yes
9983
9984 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9985 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9986 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9987 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9988 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009989
9990 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9991 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9992
9993 global
9994 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9995
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009996 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009997 load-server-state-from-file
9998
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009999 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010000 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010001
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010002server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10003 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10004 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10006 no | no | yes | yes
10007
10008 Arguments:
10009 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10010
10011 <num | range>
10012 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10013 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10014 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10015 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10016
10017 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10018
10019 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10020
10021 <params*>
10022 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10023 keyword.
10024
10025 Examples:
10026 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10027 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10028 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10029
10030 # or
10031 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10032
10033 # would be equivalent to:
10034 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10035 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10036 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10037
10038
10039
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010040source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010041source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010042source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010043 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10045 yes | no | yes | yes
10046 Arguments :
10047 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10048 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010049
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010050 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010051 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10052 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10053 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10054 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10055 supported prefixes are :
10056 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10057 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10058 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010059 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010060 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10061 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010062
10063 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10064 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010065 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10066 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10067 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010068
10069 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10070 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10071 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10072 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10073 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10074 <addr>.
10075
10076 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10077 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10078 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10079 port.
10080
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010081 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10082 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10083 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10084 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010085 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010086 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10087 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10088 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10089 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10090 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10091 HTTP header.
10092
10093 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10094 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010095 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010096 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10097 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10098 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10099 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10100 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10101 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10102 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10103
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010104 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10105 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10106 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10107 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10108 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10109 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10110
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010111 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10112 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10113 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10114 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10115
10116 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10117 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10118 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10119 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10120 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10121 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10122
10123 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10124 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10125 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10126 there are two methods :
10127
10128 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10129 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10130 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10131 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10132 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10133 of the client ranges may be used.
10134
10135 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10136 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10137 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10138 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10139 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10140 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10141 same session.
10142
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010143 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10144 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10145 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010146 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010147
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010148 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10149
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010150 Examples :
10151 backend private
10152 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10153 source 192.168.1.200
10154
10155 backend transparent_ssl1
10156 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10157 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10158
10159 backend transparent_ssl2
10160 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10161 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10162 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10163
10164 backend transparent_ssl3
10165 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10166 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10167 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10168
10169 backend transparent_smtp
10170 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10171 # with Tproxy version 4.
10172 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10173
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010174 backend transparent_http
10175 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10176 # proxy.
10177 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010179 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010180 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10181
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010182
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010183srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10184 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10185 the connection on the server side.
10186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10187 yes | no | yes | yes
10188 Arguments :
10189 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10190
10191 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10192 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010193 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10194 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010195
10196 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10197
10198
10199srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10200 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10201 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10202 server side.
10203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10204 yes | no | yes | yes
10205 Arguments :
10206 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10207 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10208 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10209 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10210
10211 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10212 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010213 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10214 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010215
10216 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10217
10218
10219srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10220 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10222 yes | no | yes | yes
10223 Arguments :
10224 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10225 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10226 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10227 document.
10228
10229 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10230 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010231 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10232 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010233
10234 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10235
10236
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010237stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10238 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010240 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010241
10242 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10243 matched.
10244
10245 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10246 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10247
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010248 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10249 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010250 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010251
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010252 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10253 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10254 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10255 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010256
10257 Example :
10258 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10259 backend stats_localhost
10260 stats enable
10261 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10262
10263 Example :
10264 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10265 backend stats_auth
10266 stats enable
10267 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10268 stats admin if TRUE
10269
10270 Example :
10271 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10272 userlist stats-auth
10273 group admin users admin
10274 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10275 group readonly users haproxy
10276 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10277
10278 backend stats_auth
10279 stats enable
10280 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10281 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10282 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10283 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10284
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010285 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10286 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10287 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010288
10289
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010290stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10291 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010293 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010294 Arguments :
10295 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10296
10297 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10298
10299 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10300 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10301 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10302 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10303 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10304 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10305
10306 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10307 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10308 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010309 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010310
10311 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10312 report using "stats scope".
10313
10314 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10315 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10316 unobvious parameters.
10317
10318 Example :
10319 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10320 backend public_www
10321 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10322 stats enable
10323 stats hide-version
10324 stats scope .
10325 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010326 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010327 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10328 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10329
10330 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10331 backend private_monitoring
10332 stats enable
10333 stats uri /admin?stats
10334 stats refresh 5s
10335
10336 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10337
10338
10339stats enable
10340 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010342 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010343 Arguments : none
10344
10345 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10346 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10347 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10348 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10349 - stats auth : no authentication
10350 - stats scope : no restriction
10351
10352 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10353 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10354 unobvious parameters.
10355
10356 Example :
10357 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10358 backend public_www
10359 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10360 stats enable
10361 stats hide-version
10362 stats scope .
10363 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010364 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010365 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10366 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10367
10368 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10369 backend private_monitoring
10370 stats enable
10371 stats uri /admin?stats
10372 stats refresh 5s
10373
10374 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10375
10376
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010377stats hide-version
10378 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010380 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010381 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010382
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010383 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10384 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10385 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10386 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10387 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10388 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010389
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010390 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10391 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10392 unobvious parameters.
10393
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010394 Example :
10395 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10396 backend public_www
10397 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010398 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010399 stats hide-version
10400 stats scope .
10401 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010402 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010403 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10404 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010405
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010406 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10407 backend private_monitoring
10408 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010409 stats uri /admin?stats
10410 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010411
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010412 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010413
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010414
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010415stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10416 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10417 Access control for statistics
10418
10419 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10420 no | no | yes | yes
10421
10422 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10423 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10424 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10425 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10426 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10427 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10428
10429 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10430 instance.
10431
10432 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10433 about ACL usage.
10434
10435
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010436stats realm <realm>
10437 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010439 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010440 Arguments :
10441 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10442 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10443 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10444
10445 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10446 using a backslash ('\').
10447
10448 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10449 only related to authentication.
10450
10451 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10452 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10453 unobvious parameters.
10454
10455 Example :
10456 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10457 backend public_www
10458 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10459 stats enable
10460 stats hide-version
10461 stats scope .
10462 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010463 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010464 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10465 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10466
10467 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10468 backend private_monitoring
10469 stats enable
10470 stats uri /admin?stats
10471 stats refresh 5s
10472
10473 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10474
10475
10476stats refresh <delay>
10477 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010479 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010480 Arguments :
10481 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10482 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10483 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10484 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10485 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10486 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10487
10488 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10489 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10490 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010491 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010492
10493 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10494 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10495 unobvious parameters.
10496
10497 Example :
10498 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10499 backend public_www
10500 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10501 stats enable
10502 stats hide-version
10503 stats scope .
10504 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010505 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010506 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10507 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10508
10509 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10510 backend private_monitoring
10511 stats enable
10512 stats uri /admin?stats
10513 stats refresh 5s
10514
10515 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10516
10517
10518stats scope { <name> | "." }
10519 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010521 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010522 Arguments :
10523 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10524 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10525 section in which the statement appears.
10526
10527 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10528 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10529 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10530 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10531 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10532 exists.
10533
10534 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10535 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10536 unobvious parameters.
10537
10538 Example :
10539 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10540 backend public_www
10541 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10542 stats enable
10543 stats hide-version
10544 stats scope .
10545 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010546 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010547 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10548 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10549
10550 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10551 backend private_monitoring
10552 stats enable
10553 stats uri /admin?stats
10554 stats refresh 5s
10555
10556 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10557
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010558
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010559stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010560 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010562 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010563
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010564 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010565 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10566
10567 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10568 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10569
10570 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10571 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010572 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010573
10574 Example :
10575 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10576 backend private_monitoring
10577 stats enable
10578 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10579 stats uri /admin?stats
10580 stats refresh 5s
10581
10582 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10583 global section.
10584
10585
10586stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010587 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10589 yes | yes | yes | yes
10590 Arguments : none
10591
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010592 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010593 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10594 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10595 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10596 - IP (socket, server)
10597 - cookie (backend, server)
10598
10599 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10600 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010601 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010602
10603 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10604
10605
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010606stats show-modules
10607 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10609 yes | yes | yes | yes
10610 Arguments : none
10611
10612 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10613 values as a tooltip.
10614
10615 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10616 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10617 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10618
10619 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10620
10621
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010622stats show-node [ <name> ]
10623 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010625 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010626 Arguments:
10627 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10628 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10629
10630 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10631 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010632 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010633
10634 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10635 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10636 unobvious parameters.
10637
10638 Example:
10639 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10640 backend private_monitoring
10641 stats enable
10642 stats show-node Europe-1
10643 stats uri /admin?stats
10644 stats refresh 5s
10645
10646 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10647 section.
10648
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010649
10650stats uri <prefix>
10651 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010653 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010654 Arguments :
10655 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10656 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10657 query string.
10658
10659 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10660 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10661 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10662 possible to reach it in the application.
10663
10664 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010665 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010666 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10667 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10668 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10669 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10670
10671 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10672 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10673 an address or a port to statistics only.
10674
10675 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10676 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10677 unobvious parameters.
10678
10679 Example :
10680 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10681 backend public_www
10682 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10683 stats enable
10684 stats hide-version
10685 stats scope .
10686 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010687 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010688 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10689 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10690
10691 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10692 backend private_monitoring
10693 stats enable
10694 stats uri /admin?stats
10695 stats refresh 5s
10696
10697 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10698
10699
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010700stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10701 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010703 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010704
10705 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010706 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010707 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010708 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010709 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10710
10711 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10712 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10713 the "stick-table" statement.
10714
10715 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10716 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10717 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10718 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10719 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10720
10721 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10722 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10723 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10724 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10725 transformation rules.
10726
10727 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10728 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10729 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10730 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10731 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10732 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10733 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10734
10735 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10736 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10737 ACL based conditions.
10738
10739 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10740 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10741 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10742 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10743
10744 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10745 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10746 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10747 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10748
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010749 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10750 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010751 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010752
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010753 Example :
10754 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10755 # last 30 minutes
10756 backend pop
10757 mode tcp
10758 balance roundrobin
10759 stick store-request src
10760 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10761 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10762 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10763
10764 backend smtp
10765 mode tcp
10766 balance roundrobin
10767 stick match src table pop
10768 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10769 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10770
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010771 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010772 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010773
10774
10775stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10776 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10778 no | no | yes | yes
10779
10780 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10781 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10782 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10783 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10784
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010785 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10786 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010787 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010788
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010789 Examples :
10790 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010791 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010792
10793 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10794 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10795 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10796
10797
10798 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10799 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10800 backend http
10801 mode http
10802 balance roundrobin
10803 stick on src table https
10804 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10805 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10806 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10807
10808 backend https
10809 mode tcp
10810 balance roundrobin
10811 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10812 stick on src
10813 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10814 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10815
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010816 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010817
10818
10819stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10820 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10822 no | no | yes | yes
10823
10824 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010825 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010826 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010827 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010828 server is selected.
10829
10830 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10831 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10832 the "stick-table" statement.
10833
10834 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10835 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10836 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10837 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10838 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10839 address.
10840
10841 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10842 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10843 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10844 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10845 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10846 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10847 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10848 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10849 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10850 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10851
10852 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10853 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10854 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10855 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10856 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10857 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10858 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10859
10860 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10861 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10862 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10863 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10864
10865 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10866 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10867 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10868 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10869 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10870 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010871 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10872 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10873 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10874 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10875 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10876 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010877
10878 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10879 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10880 the request.
10881
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010882 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10883 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010884 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010885
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010886 Example :
10887 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10888 # last 30 minutes
10889 backend pop
10890 mode tcp
10891 balance roundrobin
10892 stick store-request src
10893 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10894 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10895 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10896
10897 backend smtp
10898 mode tcp
10899 balance roundrobin
10900 stick match src table pop
10901 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10902 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10903
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010904 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010905 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010906
10907
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010908stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010909 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010910 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010911 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010913 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010914
10915 Arguments :
10916 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10917 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10918 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10919 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10920
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010921 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10922 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10923 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10924 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10925
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010926 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10927 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10928 instance.
10929
10930 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10931 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10932 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10933 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10934 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10935 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010936 to 32 characters.
10937
10938 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10939 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10940 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010941 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010942 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10943 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010944
10945 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010946 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10947 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010948 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10949 increase.
10950
10951 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010952 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10953 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10954 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010955
10956 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10957 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10958 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10959 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010960 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010961 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10962 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10963 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10964 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10965 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10966 parameter (see below).
10967
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010968 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10969 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10970 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10971 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10972 soft restart.
10973
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010974 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10975 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010976
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010977 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10978 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10979 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10980 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010010981 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010982 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010983 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10984 if not expiration delay is specified.
10985
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010986 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
10987 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
10988 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
10989 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
10990 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
10991 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
10992 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
10993 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
10994 token.
10995
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010996 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10997 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10998 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10999 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011000 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11001 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11002 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11003 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11004 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11005 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11006 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11007 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11008 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11009 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11010 types and their arguments.
11011
11012 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11013 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11014 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11015 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11016
11017 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11018 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11019 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011020 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011021
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011022 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11023 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11024 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011025 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011026 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011027 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011028
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011029 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11030 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11031 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11032 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11033
11034 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11035 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11036 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11037 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11038 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11039 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11040
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011041 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11042 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11043 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11044 they were received.
11045
11046 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11047 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11048 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11049 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11050 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11051
11052 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11053 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11054 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11055 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11056 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11057
11058 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11059 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11060 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11061
11062 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11063 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11064 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11065 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11066 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11067
11068 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11069 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11070 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11071 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11072 the client side.
11073
11074 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11075 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11076 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11077 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11078 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11079 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11080 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11081
11082 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11083 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11084 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11085 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11086 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11087 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011088 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011089
11090 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11091 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11092 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11093 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11094 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11095 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11096
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011097 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11098 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11099 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11100 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11101 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11102
11103 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11104 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11105 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11106 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11107 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11108 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11109
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011110 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011111 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011112 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11113 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11114
11115 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11116 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11117 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11118 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11119 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11120 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11121 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11122 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11123 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11124 recommended for better fairness.
11125
11126 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011127 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011128 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11129 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11130
11131 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11132 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11133 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11134 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11135 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11136 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11137 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11138 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11139 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11140 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011141
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011142 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11143 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011144 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11145 reference it.
11146
11147 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11148 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011149 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11150 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11151 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011152
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011153 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11154 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11155 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11156 something that can be ignored.
11157
11158 Example:
11159 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11160 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11161 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11162 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11163
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011164 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011165 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011166
11167
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011168stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011169 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11171 no | no | yes | yes
11172
11173 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011174 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011175 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011176 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011177 server is selected.
11178
11179 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11180 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11181 the "stick-table" statement.
11182
11183 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11184 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11185 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11186 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11187
11188 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11189 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11190 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11191 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11192 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11193 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011194 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011195 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11196 rules.
11197
11198 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11199 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11200 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11201 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11202 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11203 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11204 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11205
11206 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11207 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11208 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11209 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11210
11211 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11212 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11213 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11214 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11215 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11216 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011217 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11218 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11219 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11220 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11221 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11222 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11223 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11224 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11225 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011226
11227 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11228
11229 Example :
11230 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11231 backend https
11232 mode tcp
11233 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011234 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011235 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011236
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011237 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11238 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11239
11240 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11241 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11242 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11243
11244 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11245 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011246
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011247 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11248 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11249 # at offset 44.
11250
11251 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11252 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11253
11254 # Learn on response if server hello.
11255 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011256
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011257 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11258 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11259
11260 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11261 extraction.
11262
11263
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011264tcp-check comment <string>
11265 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11266 it fails.
11267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11268 yes | no | yes | yes
11269
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011270 Arguments :
11271 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11272 rule fails.
11273
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011274 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11275 user-friendly error reporting.
11276
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011277 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11278 "tcp-check expect".
11279
11280
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011281tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11282 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011283 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011284 Opens a new connection
11285 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011286 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011287
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011288 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011289 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11290
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011291 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011292 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011293
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011294 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011295 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11296 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011297 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011298
11299 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011300
11301 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11302
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011303 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11304
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011305 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11306
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011307 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11308
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011309 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11310 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11311 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11312 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11313
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011314 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11315 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11316 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11317 haproxy -vv.
11318
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011319 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011320
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011321 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11322 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11323 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11324
11325 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11326 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11327 of the sequence.
11328
11329 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11330 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11331 do.
11332
11333 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11334 unset-var or comment rules.
11335
11336 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011337 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11338 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11339 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11340 option tcp-check
11341 tcp-check connect
11342 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11343 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11344 tcp-check send \r\n
11345 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11346 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11347 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11348 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11349 tcp-check send \r\n
11350 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11351 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11352
11353 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11354 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011355 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011356 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11357 tcp-check connect port 143
11358 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11359 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11360
11361 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11362
11363
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011364tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011365 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011366 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011367 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011368 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011369 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011370 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011371
11372 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011373 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11374
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011375 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11376 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11377 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11378 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11379 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11380 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11381 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11382 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11383 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11384 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11385
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011386 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011387 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11388 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011389 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11390 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11391 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11392
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011393 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11394 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11395 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011396 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11397 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011398 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11399 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011400 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11401 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011402 By default "L7OK" is used.
11403
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011404 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11405 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011406 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11407 supported :
11408 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11409 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011410 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11411 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11412 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11413 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11414 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011415
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011416 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011417 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011418 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11419 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11420 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11421 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011422 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11423
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011424 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11425 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11426 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11427 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11428
11429 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11430 informational message reported in logs if an error
11431 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11432 log-format string.
11433
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011434 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11435 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11436 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11437 followed by some converters.
11438
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011439 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11440 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11441 with the usual backslash ('\').
11442 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011443 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011444 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11445 used upper or lower case.
11446
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011447 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11448
11449 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11450 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11451 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11452 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11453 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11454 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11455 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11456 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11457
11458 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11459 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11460 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11461 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11462 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11463 expression.
11464
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011465 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11466 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11467 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11468 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11469 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11470 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11471
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011472 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11473 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11474 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11475 this exact hexadecimal string.
11476 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11477
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011478 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11479 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11480 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11481 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11482 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11483 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11484 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11485 size.
11486
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011487 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11488 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11489 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11490 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11491 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11492 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11493 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11494 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11495 in a binary string before matching the response's
11496 buffer.
11497
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011498 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011499 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011500 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11501 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11502 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11503 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11504 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11505 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11506 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11507 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11508 the null character.
11509
11510 Examples :
11511 # perform a POP check
11512 option tcp-check
11513 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11514
11515 # perform an IMAP check
11516 option tcp-check
11517 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11518
11519 # look for the redis master server
11520 option tcp-check
11521 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011522 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011523 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11524 tcp-check expect string role:master
11525 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11526 tcp-check expect string +OK
11527
11528
11529 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011530 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011531
11532
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011533tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11534tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11535 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11536 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011538 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011539
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011540 Arguments :
11541 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11542
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011543 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11544 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011545
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011546 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11547 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011548
11549 Examples :
11550 # look for the redis master server
11551 option tcp-check
11552 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11553 tcp-check expect string role:master
11554
11555 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011556 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011557
11558
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011559tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11560tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11561 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11562 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011563 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011564 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011565
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011566 Arguments :
11567 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011568
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011569 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11570 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011571
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011572 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11573 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11574 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011575
11576 Examples :
11577 # redis check in binary
11578 option tcp-check
11579 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11580 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11581
11582
11583 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011584 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011585
11586
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011587tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011588 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011589 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011590 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011591
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011592 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011593 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11594 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11595 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11596 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11597 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11598 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11599 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11600 and '-'.
11601
11602 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11603
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011604 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011605 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11606
11607
11608tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011609 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011611 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011612
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011613 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011614 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11615 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11616 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11617 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11618 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11619 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11620 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11621 and '-'.
11622
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011623 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011624 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11625
11626
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011627tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11628 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11630 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011631 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011632 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11633 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011634
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011635 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011636
11637 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11638 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011639 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11640 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11641 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11642 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11643 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11644 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011645
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011646 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11647 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11648 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11649 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011650
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011651 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011652 - accept :
11653 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11654 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11655 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011656
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011657 - reject :
11658 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11659 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11660 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11661 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11662 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11663 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11664 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11665 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11666 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11667 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11668 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011669 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011670
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011671 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11672 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11673 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11674 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11675 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11676 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11677 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11678 hosts.
11679
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011680 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11681 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11682 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11683 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11684 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11685 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11686 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11687 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11688
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011689 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11690 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11691 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11692 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11693 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11694 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11695 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11696 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11697 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011698 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11699 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011700
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011701 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011702 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011703 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11704 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11705 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011706 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011707 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011708 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11709 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11710 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11711 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11712 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11713 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11714 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011715
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011716 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011717 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011718 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011719 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011720 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11721 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11722 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011724 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11725 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11726 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11727 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011728
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011729 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11730 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11731 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11732 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11733 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011734 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11735 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11736 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11737 layer7 information is extracted.
11738
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011739 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11740 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11741 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11742 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11743 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011744
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011745 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11746 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11747 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11748 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11749
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011750 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11751 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11752 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11753 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11754
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011755 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11756 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11757 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11758 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11759 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011760
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011761 - set-src <expr> :
11762 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11763 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11764 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011765 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011766
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011767 Arguments:
11768 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11769 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011770
11771 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011772 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11773
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011774 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11775 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011776
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011777 - set-src-port <expr> :
11778 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11779 expression.
11780
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011781 Arguments:
11782 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11783 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011784
11785 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011786 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11787
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011788 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11789 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11790 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011791
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011792 - set-dst <expr> :
11793 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11794 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11795 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11796 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11797 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11798
11799 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11800 followed by some converters.
11801
11802 Example:
11803
11804 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11805 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11806
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011807 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11808 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11809
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011810 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11811 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11812 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11813 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11814
11815
11816 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11817 followed by some converters.
11818
11819 Example:
11820
11821 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11822
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011823 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11824 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11825 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11826
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011827 - "silent-drop" :
11828 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011829 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011830 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11831 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11832 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11833 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11834 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011835 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11836 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011837 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11838 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011839 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011840 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11841 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11842 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11843 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011845 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11846 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11847 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011849 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11850 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11851 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011852
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011853 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011854 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011855 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011857 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11858 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11859 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011860
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011861 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011862 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11863 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011864
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011865 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11866
11867 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11868
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011869 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11870
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011871 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011872
11873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011874tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11875 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011877 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011878 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011879 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11880 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011881
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011882 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011883
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011884 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011885 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11886 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011887 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
11888 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011889
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011890 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11891 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11892 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11893 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011894 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11895 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11896 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11897 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11898 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11899 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011900 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011901 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011902
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011903 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11904 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11905 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11906 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011907
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011908 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011909 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011910 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011911 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11912 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011913 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011914 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011915 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011916 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011917 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011918 - set-dst <expr>
11919 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011920 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011921 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011922 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011923 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011924 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011925 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011927 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11928 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011929 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11930 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011931
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011932 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11933 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11934 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11935 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11936 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11937 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011938
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011939 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011940 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11941 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011942
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011943 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11944 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11945 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11946 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11947 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11948 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011950 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011951 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11952 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11953 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11954 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11955 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11956 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11957 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11958 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11959 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11960 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011961
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011962 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011963 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11964 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11965 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011966
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011967 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11968 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11969
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011970 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011971 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11972 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011973
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011974 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11975 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011976 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011977 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11978 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011979 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011980 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011981 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011982 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11983 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011984 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011985 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11986 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011987
11988 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11989 followed by some converters.
11990
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011991 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
11992 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
11993 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
11994 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
11995 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
11996 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
11997 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
11998 warning. These directives will be conditionnaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
11999 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12000 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12001
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012002 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12003
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012004 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12005 <var-name>.
12006
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012007 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12008 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12009 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12010 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12011 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12012
12013 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12014 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12015 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12016 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12017 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12018 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12019 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12020 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12021 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12022 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12023 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12024
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012025 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12026 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12027 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12028 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12029 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12030
12031 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12032
12033 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12034
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012035 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12036 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12037 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12038 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12039 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12040 evaluated.
12041
12042 Example:
12043 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12044
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012045 Example:
12046
12047 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012048 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012049
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012050 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012051 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012052 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012053 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12054 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012055 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012056 tcp-request content reject
12057
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012058 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12059 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12060 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12061 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12062 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12063 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12064 ...
12065 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12066
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012067 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012068 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12069 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12070 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012071 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012072
12073 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12074 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12075 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012076 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012077 tcp-request content reject
12078
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012079 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012080 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012081 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012082 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012083 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12084 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012085
12086 Example:
12087 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12088 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012089 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012091 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012092 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012093
12094 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012095 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012096 # protecting all our sites
12097 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012098 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12099 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012100 ...
12101 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12102
12103 backend http_dynamic
12104 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012105 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012106 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012107 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012108 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012109 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012110 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012111
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012113
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012114 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12115 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012116
12117
12118tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12119 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012121 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012122 Arguments :
12123 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12124 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12125 as explained at the top of this document.
12126
12127 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12128 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12129 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12130 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12131 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12132
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012133 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12134 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12135 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12136 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12137
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012138 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12139 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012140 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012141 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012142 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12143 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12144 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12145 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012146
12147 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12148 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12149 it pass through unaffected.
12150
12151 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12152 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12153 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012154 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012155 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12156 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012157 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12158 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12159 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012160
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012161 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012162 "timeout client".
12163
12164
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012165tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12166 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12168 no | no | yes | yes
12169 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012170 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12171 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012172
12173 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012175 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012176 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12177 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012178 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12179 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012180
12181 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12182
12183 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12184 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12185 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12186 inserted.
12187
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012188 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012189 - accept :
12190 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12191 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12192 the rules evaluation.
12193
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012194 - close :
12195 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12196 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12197 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12198 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12199 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12200 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012201 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012202 protocols.
12203
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012204 - reject :
12205 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12206 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012207 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012208
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012209 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12210 Sets a variable.
12211
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012212 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12213 Unsets a variable.
12214
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012215 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12216 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12217 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12218 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12219
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012220 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12221 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12222 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12223 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12224
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012225 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12226 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12227 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12228 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12229 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012230
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012231 - "silent-drop" :
12232 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012233 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012234 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12235 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12236 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12237 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12238 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012239 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12240 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012241 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12242 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012243 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012244 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12245 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12246 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12247 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12248
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012249 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12250 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12251
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012252 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12253 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12254 for changing the default action to a reject.
12255
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012256 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12257 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12258 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12259 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012260 period.
12261
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012262 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12263 declared inline.
12264
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012265 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12266 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012267 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012268 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12269 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012270 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012271 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012272 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012273 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12274 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012275 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012276 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12277 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012278
12279 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12280 followed by some converters.
12281
12282 Example:
12283
12284 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12285
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012286 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12287 <var-name>.
12288
12289 Example:
12290
12291 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12292
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012293 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12294 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12295 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12296 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12297 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12298
12299 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12300
12301 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12302
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012303 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12304
12305 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12306
12307
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012308tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12309 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12311 no | yes | yes | no
12312 Arguments :
12313 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12314 below.
12315
12316 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12317
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012318 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012319 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12320 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12321 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12322 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12323 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12324 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12325 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012326 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012327 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12328 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12329 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12330 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12331 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12332 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12333 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12334 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12335 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12336 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12337 instead.
12338
12339 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12340 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12341 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12342 rules which may be inserted.
12343
12344 Several types of actions are supported :
12345 - accept : the request is accepted
12346 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12347 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12348 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012349 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012350 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012351 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012352 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012353 - silent-drop
12354
12355 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12356 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12357 sections for a complete description.
12358
12359 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12360 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12361 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12362
12363 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12364 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12365 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12366 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12367 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12368
12369 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12370 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12371
12372 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12373 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12374 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12375
12376 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12377 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12378 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12379
12380 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12381 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12382 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12383
12384 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12385 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12386 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12387
12388 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12389
12390 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12391
12392
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012393tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12394 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12396 no | no | yes | yes
12397 Arguments :
12398 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12399 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12400 as explained at the top of this document.
12401
12402 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12403
12404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012405timeout check <timeout>
12406 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12407 established.
12408
12409 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12410 yes | no | yes | yes
12411 Arguments:
12412 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12413 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12414 as explained at the top of this document.
12415
12416 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12417 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012418 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012419 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012420 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12421 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12422 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012423
12424 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12425 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12426
12427 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12428 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012429 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012430
12431 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12432 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12433 forget about it.
12434
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012435 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12436 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012437
12438
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012439timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012440 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12442 yes | yes | yes | no
12443 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012444 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012445 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12446 as explained at the top of this document.
12447
12448 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12449 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12450 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012451 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12452 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12453 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12454 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012455 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12456 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12457 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012458 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012459 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012460 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12461 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012462 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12463 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012464
12465 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12466 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12467 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12468 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012469 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012470 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12471
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012472 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012473
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012474 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012476
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012477timeout client-fin <timeout>
12478 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12480 yes | yes | yes | no
12481 Arguments :
12482 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12483 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12484 as explained at the top of this document.
12485
12486 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12487 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12488 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12489 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12490 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12491 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12492 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012493 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12494 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12495 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012496
12497 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12498 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12499 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12500
12501 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12502
12503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012504timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012505 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12507 yes | no | yes | yes
12508 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012509 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012510 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12511 as explained at the top of this document.
12512
12513 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012514 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012515 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012516 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012517 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12518 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012519
12520 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12521 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12522 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12523 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012524 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012525 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12526
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012527 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012529
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012530timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12531 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12533 yes | yes | yes | yes
12534 Arguments :
12535 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12536 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12537 as explained at the top of this document.
12538
12539 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12540 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12541 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12542 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12543 once the request has started to present itself.
12544
12545 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12546 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12547 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12548 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12549 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12550
12551 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12552 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12553 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12554 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12555
12556 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12557 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012558 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012559 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12560 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012561 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012562
12563 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12564 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12565 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12566 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12567
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012568 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12569 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012570 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12571
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012572 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12573
12574
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012575timeout http-request <timeout>
12576 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012578 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012579 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012580 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012581 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12582 as explained at the top of this document.
12583
12584 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12585 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12586 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12587 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12588 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12589 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12590 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012591 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12592 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12593 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12594 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012595 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012596 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12597 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012598
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012599 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12600 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12601 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12602 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12603 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012604 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012605
12606 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12607 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012608 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012609 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12610 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12611
12612 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012613 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12614 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12615 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012616
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012617 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012618 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012619
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012620
12621timeout queue <timeout>
12622 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12624 yes | no | yes | yes
12625 Arguments :
12626 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12627 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12628 as explained at the top of this document.
12629
12630 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12631 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12632 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12633 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12634 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12635
12636 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12637 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12638 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12639 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12640
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012641 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012642
12643
12644timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012645 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12647 yes | no | yes | yes
12648 Arguments :
12649 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12650 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12651 as explained at the top of this document.
12652
12653 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12654 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12655 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12656 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12657 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12658 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12659 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12660
12661 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12662 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12663 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12664 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12665 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012666 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012667 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012668 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12669 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012670 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12671 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012672
12673 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12674 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12675 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12676 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012677 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012678 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12679
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012680 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012681
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012682
12683timeout server-fin <timeout>
12684 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12686 yes | no | yes | yes
12687 Arguments :
12688 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12689 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12690 as explained at the top of this document.
12691
12692 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12693 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12694 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12695 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12696 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12697 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12698 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12699 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12700 situations, it should not be needed.
12701
12702 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12703 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12704 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12705
12706 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12707
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012708
12709timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012710 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12712 yes | yes | yes | yes
12713 Arguments :
12714 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12715 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12716 as explained at the top of this document.
12717
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012718 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12719 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12720 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012721
12722 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12723 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12724 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12725 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012726 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012727
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012728 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012729
12730
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012731timeout tunnel <timeout>
12732 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12734 yes | no | yes | yes
12735 Arguments :
12736 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12737 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12738 as explained at the top of this document.
12739
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012740 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012741 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12742 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12743 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012744 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12745 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012746 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12747 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12748 specified.
12749
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012750 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12751 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12752 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12753 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12754 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12755 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12756 state.
12757
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012758 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12759 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12760 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12761 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012762 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012763
12764 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12765 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12766 forget about it.
12767
12768 Example :
12769 defaults http
12770 option http-server-close
12771 timeout connect 5s
12772 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012773 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012774 timeout server 30s
12775 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12776
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012777 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012778
12779
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012780transparent (deprecated)
12781 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012783 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012784 Arguments : none
12785
12786 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12787 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12788 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12789 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12790 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12791 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12792 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12793 appropriate server.
12794
12795 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12796
12797 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12798 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12799
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012800 See also: "option transparent"
12801
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012802unique-id-format <string>
12803 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12805 yes | yes | yes | no
12806 Arguments :
12807 <string> is a log-format string.
12808
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012809 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12810 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12811 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12812 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012813
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012814 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12815 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12816 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12817 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12818 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12819 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12820 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12821 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012822
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012823 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12824 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012825
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012826 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012827
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012828 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012829
12830 will generate:
12831
12832 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12833
12834 See also: "unique-id-header"
12835
12836unique-id-header <name>
12837 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12839 yes | yes | yes | no
12840 Arguments :
12841 <name> is the name of the header.
12842
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012843 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12844 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012845
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012846 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012847
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012848 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012849 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12850
12851 will generate:
12852
12853 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12854
12855 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012856
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012857use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012858 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12860 no | yes | yes | no
12861 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012862 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12863 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012864
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012865 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12866 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012867
12868 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12869 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12870 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012871 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012872 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012873 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12874 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012875
12876 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12877 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12878 assign the backend.
12879
12880 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12881 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12882 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12883 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12884 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12885 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12886
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012887 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012888 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012889 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12890 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12891 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12892
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012893 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12894 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12895 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12896 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12897 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12898 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12899 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12900 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12901 cannot be forced from the request.
12902
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012903 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012904 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12905 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12906
12907 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12908 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012909
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012910use-fcgi-app <name>
12911 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12913 no | no | yes | yes
12914 Arguments :
12915 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12916
12917 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012918
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012919use-server <server> if <condition>
12920use-server <server> unless <condition>
12921 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12923 no | no | yes | yes
12924 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012925 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12926 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012927
12928 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12929
12930 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12931 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12932 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12933
12934 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12935 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12936 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12937 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12938 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12939 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12940 matches will assign the server.
12941
12942 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12943 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12944 with the next rules until one matches.
12945
12946 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12947 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12948 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12949 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12950
12951 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12952 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12953 stripped.
12954
12955 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12956 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012957 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12958 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12959 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012960
12961 Example :
12962 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12963 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12964 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12965 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012966 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012967 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012968 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012969 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12970 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12971
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012972 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12973 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12974 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12975 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012976 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012977 and we fall back to load balancing.
12978
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012979 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012980
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012981
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100129825. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012983--------------------------
12984
12985The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12986depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12987settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12988written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12989described in this section.
12990
12991
129925.1. Bind options
12993-----------------
12994
12995The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12996as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12997no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12998parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12999while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13000provided immediately after the setting name.
13001
13002The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13003
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013004accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13005 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13006 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13007 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13008 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13009 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13010 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13011 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13012 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13013 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013014 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13015 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13016 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013017
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013018accept-proxy
13019 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013020 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13021 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013022 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13023 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13024 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13025 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013026 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013027 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13028 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013029 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13030 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013031
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013032allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013033 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013034 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013035 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013036 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13037 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013038
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013039alpn <protocols>
13040 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13041 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13042 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013043 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013044 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013045 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13046 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13047 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13048 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13049 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13050 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13051 preference, like below :
13052
13053 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013054
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013055backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013056 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013057 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13058
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013059curves <curves>
13060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13061 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13062 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13063 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13064 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13065 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13066
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013067ecdhe <named curve>
13068 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013069 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13070 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013071
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013072ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013073 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13074 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13075 client's certificate.
13076
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013077ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13079 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13080 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13081 error is ignored.
13082
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013083ca-sign-file <cafile>
13084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13085 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13086 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13087 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13088 'generate-certificates' for details.
13089
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013090ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13092 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13093 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13094 'generate-certificates' for details.
13095
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013096ca-verify-file <cafile>
13097 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13098 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13099 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13100 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13101 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13102
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013103ciphers <ciphers>
13104 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13105 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013106 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013107 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013108 information and recommendations see e.g.
13109 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13110 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13111 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13112
13113ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13115 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13116 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13117 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013118 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13119 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013120
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013121crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13123 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13124 to verify client's certificate.
13125
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013126crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13128 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13129 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13130 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13131 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013132 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13133 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013134
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013135 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13136 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13137
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013138 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13139 are loaded.
13140
13141 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013142 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13143 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13144 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13145 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13146 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13147 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13148 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013149 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013150
13151 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13152 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13153 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13154 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013155 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13156 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013157
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013158 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013159
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013160 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013161 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013162 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13163 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013164 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13165 clients).
13166
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013167 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13168 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13169 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13170 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13171 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13172 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13173 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13174 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13175 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13176 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13177 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13178 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13179 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13180
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013181 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13182 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13183 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13184 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13185 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13186
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013187 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13188 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13189 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13190 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013191
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013192 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13193 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13194 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013195
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013196crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013198 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013199 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013200 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013201
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013202crt-list <file>
13203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013204 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13205 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013206
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013207 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13208
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013209 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13210 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13211 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13212 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13213 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013214
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013215 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013216 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13217 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13218 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13219 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13220 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013221 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13222 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13223 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013224
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013225 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13226 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13227 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013228
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013229 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13230
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013231 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13232 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13233 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13234 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13235 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13236 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13237 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13238 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013239
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013240 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013241 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013242 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013243 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013244 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013245 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013246
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013247defer-accept
13248 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13249 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13250 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013251 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013252 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13253 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13254 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13255 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13256 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13257 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13258 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13259
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013260expose-fd listeners
13261 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13262 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013263 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13264 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013266
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013267force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013268 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013269 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013270 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013271 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013272
13273force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013274 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013275 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013276 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013277
13278force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013279 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013280 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013281 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013282
13283force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013284 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013285 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013286 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013287
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013288force-tlsv13
13289 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13290 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013291 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013292
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013293generate-certificates
13294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13295 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13296 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13297 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13298 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13299 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13300 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13301 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13302 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13303 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13304 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13305
13306 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13307 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013308 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013309 certificate is used many times.
13310
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013311gid <gid>
13312 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13313 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13314 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13315 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13316 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13317
13318group <group>
13319 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13320 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13321 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13322 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13323 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13324
13325id <id>
13326 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13327 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13328 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13329 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13330
13331interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013332 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13333 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13334 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13335 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13336 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13337 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013338 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13339 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13340 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13341 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13342 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13343 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013344
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013345level <level>
13346 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13347 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13348 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013349 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013350 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13351 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13352 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013353 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013354 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013355 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013356 all counters).
13357
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013358severity-output <format>
13359 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13360 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13361 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13362 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13363 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13364 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13365 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13366 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13367 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13368 rfc5424 convention.
13369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013370maxconn <maxconn>
13371 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13372 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13373 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13374 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13375 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13376 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13377 eat all memory.
13378
13379mode <mode>
13380 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13381 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13382 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13383 UNIX sockets.
13384
13385mss <maxseg>
13386 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13387 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13388 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13389 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13390 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13391 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13392 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13393 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13394 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13395 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13396 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13397
13398name <name>
13399 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13400 page.
13401
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013402namespace <name>
13403 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13404 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13405 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13406 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13407
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013408nice <nice>
13409 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13410 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13411 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13412 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13413 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13414 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13415 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13416 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13417 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13418 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13419 one for an RDP socket.
13420
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013421no-ca-names
13422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13423 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013424 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013425
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013426no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013428 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013429 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013430 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013431 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13432 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013433
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013434no-tls-tickets
13435 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13436 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13437 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013438 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13439 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013440 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13441 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13442 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013443
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013444no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013445 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013446 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013447 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013448 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013449 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13450 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013451
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013452no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013454 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013455 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013456 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013457 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13458 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013459
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013460no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013462 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013463 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013464 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013465 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13466 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013467
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013468no-tlsv13
13469 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13470 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13471 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13472 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013473 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13474 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013475
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013476npn <protocols>
13477 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13478 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13479 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013480 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013481 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013482 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13483 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13484 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13485 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13486 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013487
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013488prefer-client-ciphers
13489 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13490 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13491 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013492 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13493 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13494 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013495
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013496process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013497 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013498 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013499 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013500 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13501 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13502 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13503 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013504 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013505 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13506 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13507 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13508 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13509 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013510
13511 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13512
13513 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13514 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13515 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13516 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13517 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13518 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13519 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13520 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013521
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013522proto <name>
13523 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13524 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13525 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013526 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13527 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13528
13529 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13530 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13531 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13532 also reported (flag=HTX).
13533
13534 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13535 a bind line :
13536
13537 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13538 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13539 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13540
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013541 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013542 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013543 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013544 h2" on the bind line.
13545
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013546ssl
13547 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013548 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013549 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13550 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013551 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13552 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013553
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013554ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13555 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013556 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13557 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13558 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013559 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13560
13561ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013562 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13563 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13564 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13565 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013566
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013567strict-sni
13568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13569 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13570 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13571 See the "crt" option for more information.
13572
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013573tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013574 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013575 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13576 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013577 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013578 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13579 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13580 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13581 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13582 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13583 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13584 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13585
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013586tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013587 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013588 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13589 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13590 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13591 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13592 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13593 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13594 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013595 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13596 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13597 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013598
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013599tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13600 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013601 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13602 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13603 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13604 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13605 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13606 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13607 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13608 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13609 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13610 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013611 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13612 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013614transparent
13615 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13616 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13617 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13618 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13619 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13620 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13621 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13622 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13623 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13624 so check for support with your vendor.
13625
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013626v4v6
13627 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13628 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13629 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13630 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013631 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013632
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013633v6only
13634 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13635 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13636 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013637 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13638 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013639
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013640uid <uid>
13641 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13642 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13643 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13644 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13645 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13646
13647user <user>
13648 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13649 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13650 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13651 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13652 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13653
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013654verify [none|optional|required]
13655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13656 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13657 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13658 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13659 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013660 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13661 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13662 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13663 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200136655.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013666------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013668The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13669which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13670arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13671settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13672after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13673Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13674address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013676 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013677 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013678
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013679Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13680keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013682The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013683
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013684addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013685 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013686 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13687 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13688 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13689 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13690 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013691
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013692agent-check
13693 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013694 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013695 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13696 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13697 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013698
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013699 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013700 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013701 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13702 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13703 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013704
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013705 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13706 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13707 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13708 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13709 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013710
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013711 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013712 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013713
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013714 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13715 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13716 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013717
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013718 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13719 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13720 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013721
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013722 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013723 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13724 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13725 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13726 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013727 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013728 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013729
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013730 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13731 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013732
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013733 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13734 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13735 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13736 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13737 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13738 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13739 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13740 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13741 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013742
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013743 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13744 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013745 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13746 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13747 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013748 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013749
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013750 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013751 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013752
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013753agent-send <string>
13754 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13755 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13756 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13757 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13758 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13759
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013760agent-inter <delay>
13761 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13762 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13763
13764 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13765 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13766 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13767 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13768 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13769 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13770 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13771 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13772 of backends use the same servers.
13773
13774 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13775
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013776agent-addr <addr>
13777 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13778
13779 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13780 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13781 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13782 hostname, it will be resolved.
13783
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013784agent-port <port>
13785 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13786
13787 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13788
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013789allow-0rtt
13790 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013791 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13792 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013793
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013794alpn <protocols>
13795 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13796 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13797 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013798 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013799 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13800 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13801 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13802 now obsolete NPN extension.
13803 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13804 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13805
13806 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013808backup
13809 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13810 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13811 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13812 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013813 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13814 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013815
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013816ca-file <cafile>
13817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13818 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13819 server's certificate.
13820
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013821check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013822 This option enables health checks on a server:
13823 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13824 considered available.
13825 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13826 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13827 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13828 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13829 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13830 set.
13831 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13832 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13833 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13834 exchanges succeed.
13835
13836 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13837 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13838 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13839 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13840 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013841 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013842 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13843
13844 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13845 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13846
13847 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13848 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13849
13850 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13851 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13852 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13853 available.
13854
13855 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13856 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13857 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13858
13859 Example:
13860 # simple tcp check
13861 backend foo
13862 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13863 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13864 backend foo
13865 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13866 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13867 backend foo
13868 option tcp-check
13869 tcp-check connect
13870 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013871
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013872check-send-proxy
13873 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13874 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13875 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13876 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13877 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13878 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13879 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13880
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013881check-alpn <protocols>
13882 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13883 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13884 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13885
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013886check-proto <name>
13887 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13888 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13889 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013890 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
13891 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13892
13893 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13894 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13895 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13896 also reported (flag=HTX).
13897
13898 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
13899 directive on a server line:
13900
13901 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13902 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13903 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13904 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13905
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013906 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013907 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13908 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13909
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013910check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013911 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013912 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13913 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013914
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013915check-ssl
13916 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13917 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13918 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13919 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013920 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013921 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13922 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013923 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013924 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13925 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013926
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013927check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013928 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013929 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13930 for normal traffic.
13931
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013932ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13934 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13935 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013936 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13937 information and recommendations see e.g.
13938 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13939 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13940 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013941
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013942ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13944 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13945 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13946 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013947 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13948 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13949 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013951cookie <value>
13952 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13953 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13954 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13955 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13956 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13957 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13958 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13959
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013960crl-file <crlfile>
13961 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13962 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13963 to verify server's certificate.
13964
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013965crt <cert>
13966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13967 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13968 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13969 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13970 certificate request.
13971
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013972disabled
13973 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13974 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13975 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13976 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13977 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013978 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013979
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013980enabled
13981 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13982 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13983 default value.
13984 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13985 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013987error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013988 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13989 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13990 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013992 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013994fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013995 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13996 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13997 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13998
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013999force-sslv3
14000 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14001 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014002 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014003 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014004
14005force-tlsv10
14006 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014007 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014008 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014009
14010force-tlsv11
14011 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014012 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014013 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014014
14015force-tlsv12
14016 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014017 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014018 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014019
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014020force-tlsv13
14021 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14022 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014023 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014025id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014026 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14027 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14028 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014029
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014030init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14031 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14032 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014033 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014034 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14035 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14036 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14037 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14038 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14039 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14040 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14041 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14042 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014043 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014044 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14045 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14046 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14047 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14048 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14049 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014050 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014051
14052 Example:
14053 defaults
14054 # never fail on address resolution
14055 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014057inter <delay>
14058fastinter <delay>
14059downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014060 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14061 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14062 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14063 between checks depending on the server state :
14064
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014065 Server state | Interval used
14066 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14067 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14068 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14069 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14070 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14071 or yet unchecked. |
14072 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14073 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14074 | "inter" otherwise.
14075 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014077 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14078 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14079 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14080 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014081 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14082 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14083 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14084 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14085 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014086
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014087log-proto <logproto>
14088 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14089 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14090 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14091 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014093maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014094 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14095 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014096 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14097 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014098 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14099 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14100 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14101 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14102
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014103 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14104 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14105 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14106 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14107 than 50 concurrent requests.
14108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014109maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14111 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14112 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14113 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014114 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14115 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14116 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14117 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14118 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14119 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14120 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014121
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014122max-reuse <count>
14123 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14124 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14125 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14126 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14127 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14128 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14129 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14130 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014132minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014133 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14134 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14135 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14136 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14137 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14138 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014139 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014140 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014141
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014142namespace <name>
14143 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14144 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14145 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14146 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14147
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014148no-agent-check
14149 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14150 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14151 default value.
14152 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14153 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14154
14155no-backup
14156 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14157 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14158 default value.
14159 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14160 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14161
14162no-check
14163 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14164 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14165 default value.
14166 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14167 "default-server" "check" setting.
14168
14169no-check-ssl
14170 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14171 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14172 default value.
14173 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14174 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14175
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014176no-send-proxy
14177 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14178 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14179 default value.
14180 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14181 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14182
14183no-send-proxy-v2
14184 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14185 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14186 default value.
14187 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14188 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14189
14190no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14191 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14192 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14193 default value.
14194 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14195 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14196
14197no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14198 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14199 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14200 default value.
14201 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14202 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14203
14204no-ssl
14205 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14206 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14207 default value.
14208 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14209 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14210
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014211 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14212 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14213 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14214
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014215no-ssl-reuse
14216 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14217 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14218 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14219 and for paranoid users.
14220
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014221no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014222 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14223 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014224 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014225
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014226 Supported in default-server: No
14227
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014228no-tls-tickets
14229 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14230 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14231 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014232 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14233 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014234 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14235 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14236 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014237 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014238
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014239no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014240 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014241 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14242 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014243 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14244 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014245 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014246
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014247 Supported in default-server: No
14248
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014249no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014250 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014251 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14252 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014253 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14254 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014255 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014256
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014257 Supported in default-server: No
14258
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014259no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014260 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014261 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14262 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014263 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14264 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014265 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014266
14267 Supported in default-server: No
14268
14269no-tlsv13
14270 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14271 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14272 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14273 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14274 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014275 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014276
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014277 Supported in default-server: No
14278
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014279no-verifyhost
14280 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14281 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14282 default value.
14283 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14284 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014285
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014286no-tfo
14287 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14288 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14289 default value.
14290 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14291 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14292
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014293non-stick
14294 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14295 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14296 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14297
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014298npn <protocols>
14299 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14300 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14301 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014302 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014303 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14304 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14305 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014307observe <mode>
14308 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14309 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14310 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14311 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14312 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14313 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014314 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014315
14316 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14317
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014318on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014319 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14320 Currently, four modes are available:
14321 - fastinter: force fastinter
14322 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14323 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14324 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14325 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14326
14327 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14328
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014329on-marked-down <action>
14330 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14331 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014332 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14333 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14334 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14335 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14336 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14337 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14338 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14339 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014340
14341 Actions are disabled by default
14342
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014343on-marked-up <action>
14344 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14345 Currently one action is available:
14346 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14347 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14348 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14349 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014350 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14351 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014352 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14353 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14354
14355 Actions are disabled by default
14356
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014357pool-low-conn <max>
14358 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14359 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14360 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14361 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14362 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14363 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14364 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14365 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14366 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14367 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014368 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14369 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14370 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14371 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014372
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014373pool-max-conn <max>
14374 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14375 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14376 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14377 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14378 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14379 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14380
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014381pool-purge-delay <delay>
14382 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014383 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014384 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014386port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014387 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014388 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14389 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14390 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14391 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14392 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014393
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014394proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014395 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14396 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14397 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014398 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14399 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14400
14401 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14402 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14403 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14404 also reported (flag=HTX).
14405
14406 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14407 a server line :
14408
14409 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14410 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14411 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14412 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14413
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014414 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014415 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14416
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014417redir <prefix>
14418 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14419 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14420 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14421 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14422 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14423 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14424 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14425 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014426 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014427 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014428 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14429 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14430 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14431 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14432
14433 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14434
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014435rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014436 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14437 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14438 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14439
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014440resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14441 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14442 server.
14443
14444 Available options:
14445
14446 * allow-dup-ip
14447 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14448 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14449 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14450 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14451 For such case, simply enable this option.
14452 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14453
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014454 * ignore-weight
14455 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14456 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14457 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14458
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014459 * prevent-dup-ip
14460 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14461 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14462 same fqdn.
14463 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14464
14465 Example:
14466 backend b_myapp
14467 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14468 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14469 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14470
14471 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14472 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14473 it
14474 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14475 different address
14476
14477 Default value: not set
14478
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014479resolve-prefer <family>
14480 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14481 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14482 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14483 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14484
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014485 Default value: ipv6
14486
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014487 Example:
14488
14489 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014490
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014491resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014492 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014493 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014494 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014495 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14496 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014497 configured network, another address is selected.
14498
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014499 Example:
14500
14501 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014502
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014503resolvers <id>
14504 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14505 hostname.
14506
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014507 Example:
14508
14509 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014510
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014511 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014512
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014513send-proxy
14514 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14515 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14516 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14517 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014518 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14519 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14520 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14521 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14522 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14523 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14524 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14525 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14526 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14527 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014528 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14529 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014530
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014531send-proxy-v2
14532 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14533 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14534 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14535 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014536 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14537 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14538 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14539 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014540
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014541proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014542 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14543 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14544
14545 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14546 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14547 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14548 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14549 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14550 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14551 connection is supported).
14552 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14553 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14554 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14555 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14556 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14557 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14558 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014559
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014560send-proxy-v2-ssl
14561 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14562 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14563 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14564 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14565 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14566 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14567 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014568 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14569 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014570
14571send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14572 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14573 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14574 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14575 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14576 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14577 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14578 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14579 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014580 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14581 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014582
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014583slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014584 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14585 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14586 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14587 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14588 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14589 parameters :
14590
14591 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14592 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14593
14594 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14595 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14596 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14597 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14598
14599 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14600 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14601 seen as failed.
14602
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014603sni <expression>
14604 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14605 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14606 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14607 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014608 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14609 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014610 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014611 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14612 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014613
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014614source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014615source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014616source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014617 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14618 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14619 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14620 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14621
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014622 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14623 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14624 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14625 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14626 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14627 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14628 server.
14629
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014630 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14631 specifying the source address without port(s).
14632
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014633ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014634 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14635 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14636 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14637 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14638 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14639 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014640 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14641 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014642
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014643ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14644 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14645 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14646 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14647
14648ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14649 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14650 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14651 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14652
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014653ssl-reuse
14654 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14655 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14656 default value.
14657 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14658 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14659
14660stick
14661 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14662 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14663 default value.
14664 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14665 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014666
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014667socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014668 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014669 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14670 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14671
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014672tcp-ut <delay>
14673 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14674 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14675 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014676 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014677 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14678 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14679 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14680 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14681 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14682 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14683 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14684 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14685 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14686
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014687tfo
14688 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14689 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14690 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14691 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14692 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014693 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014695track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014696 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14697 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14698 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14699 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014700 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14701
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014702tls-tickets
14703 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14704 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14705 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014706 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14707 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14708 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014709 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014710 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014711
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014712verify [none|required]
14713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014714 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014715 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14716 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014717 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014718 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14719 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14720 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14721 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14722 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14723 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14724 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14725 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014726
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014727verifyhost <hostname>
14728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014729 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14730 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14731 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14732 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14733 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14734 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14735 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14736 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014737
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014738weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014739 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14740 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14741 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014742 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14743 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14744 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14745 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14746 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14747 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014748
14749
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147505.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14751-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014752
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014753HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14754using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014755configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014756This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14757can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14758workload.
14759This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14760resolution at run time.
14761Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14762carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14763
14764
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147655.3.1. Global overview
14766----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014767
14768As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14769different steps of the process life:
14770
14771 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14772 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14773 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14774
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014775 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14776 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014777
14778A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14779 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14780 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14781 resolution to know this new IP.
14782
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014783When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014784HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014785SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14786from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14787will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14788will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014789
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014790A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014791 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014792 first valid response.
14793
14794 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14795 servers return an error.
14796
14797
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147985.3.2. The resolvers section
14799----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014800
14801This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014802HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14803contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014804
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014805When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14806uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14807is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14808answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14809
14810When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014811used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014812
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014813 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14814 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14815 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014816
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014817 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14818 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014819
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014820 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14821 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14822 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014823
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014824For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14825following scenarios are possible:
14826
14827 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14828 ignored
14829
14830 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14831 applied
14832
14833 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14834 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14835
14836 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14837 retries the query with a new type
14838
14839 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14840 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014841
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014842As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14843a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014844<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014845
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014846
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014847resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014848 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014849
14850A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14851
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014852accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014853 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014854 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014855 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14856 by RFC 6891)
14857
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010014858 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
14859 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
14860 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
14861 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
14862 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
14863 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014864
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014865nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
14866 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
14867 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
14868 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
14869 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
14870 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
14871 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
14872 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
14873 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
14874 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014875 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14876
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014877parse-resolv-conf
14878 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14879 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14880 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14881
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014882hold <status> <period>
14883 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14884 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014885 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014886 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014887 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14888 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14889 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14890
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014891 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014892
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014893resolve_retries <nb>
14894 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14895 giving up.
14896 Default value: 3
14897
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014898 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14899 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14900 type.
14901
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014902timeout <event> <time>
14903 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14904 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14905 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014906 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14907 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014908 Default value: 1s
14909 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014910 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014911 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014912 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14913 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14914
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014915 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014916
14917 resolvers mydns
14918 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14919 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014920 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014921 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014922 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014923 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014924 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014925 hold other 30s
14926 hold refused 30s
14927 hold nx 30s
14928 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014929 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014930 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014931
14932
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200149336. Cache
14934---------
14935
14936HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14937(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14938RAM.
14939
14940The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14941this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14942
14943If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14944independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14945when we try to allocate a new one.
14946
14947The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14948
14949It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14950"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14951for more details.
14952
14953When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14954replaced by "<CACHE>".
14955
14956
149576.1. Limitation
14958----------------
14959
14960The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14961
14962- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014963- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14964 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14965 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014966- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14967- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014968- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14969 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14970 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014971- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
14972 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010014973- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
14974 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
14975 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014976
14977- If the request is not a GET
14978- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14979- If the request contains an Authorization header
14980
14981
149826.2. Setup
14983-----------
14984
14985To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14986the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14987
14988
149896.2.1. Cache section
14990---------------------
14991
14992cache <name>
14993 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14994 size of cache is mandatory.
14995
14996total-max-size <megabytes>
14997 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14998 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14999
15000max-object-size <bytes>
15001 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15002 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15003 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15004
15005max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015006 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015007 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15008 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15009 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15010 default.
15011
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015012process-vary <on/off>
15013 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015014 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15015 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15016 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015017 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015018
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015019max-secondary-entries <number>
15020 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15021 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15022 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15023
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015024
150256.2.2. Proxy section
15026---------------------
15027
15028http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15029 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15030 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15031 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15032 after this one.
15033
15034http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15035 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15036 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15037 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15038 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15039
15040
15041Example:
15042
15043 backend bck1
15044 mode http
15045
15046 http-request cache-use foobar
15047 http-response cache-store foobar
15048 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15049
15050 cache foobar
15051 total-max-size 4
15052 max-age 240
15053
15054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150557. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15056----------------------------------
15057
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015058HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015059client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15060The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15061these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15062but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15063data called patterns.
15064
15065
150667.1. ACL basics
15067---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015068
15069The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15070content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15071from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15072simple :
15073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015075 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15077 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15080adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015081
15082In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015084 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015085
15086This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15087Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15088and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015089an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15090conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15091as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15092are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015093
15094ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15095'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15096which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15097
15098There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15099performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015101The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15102specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15103this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015104methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15105ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015106
15107Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15108 - boolean
15109 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15110 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15111 - string
15112 - data block
15113
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015114Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15115converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15116would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15117The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15118which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15119
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015120Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15121keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15122fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15123which are summarized in the table below :
15124
15125 +---------------------+-----------------+
15126 | Sample or converter | Default |
15127 | output type | matching method |
15128 +---------------------+-----------------+
15129 | boolean | bool |
15130 +---------------------+-----------------+
15131 | integer | int |
15132 +---------------------+-----------------+
15133 | ip | ip |
15134 +---------------------+-----------------+
15135 | string | str |
15136 +---------------------+-----------------+
15137 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15138 +---------------------+-----------------+
15139
15140Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15141matching method, see below.
15142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015143The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15144 - boolean
15145 - integer or integer range
15146 - IP address / network
15147 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15148 - regular expression
15149 - hex block
15150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015151The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15152
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015153 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15154 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015155 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015156 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015157 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015158 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015159 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015161The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15162read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15163if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15164lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15165will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15166beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15167a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15168lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15169exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15170
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015171The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15172parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15173ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15174a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15175check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15176
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015177The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15178socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15179file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15182loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15183
15184 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15185
15186In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15187the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15188case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15189as well.
15190
15191The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15192sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15193do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15194methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15195is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015196obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15198default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15199that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15200string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15201
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015202The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15203By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15204string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15205resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15206server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015207waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015208flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15209function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15212sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15213be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015214
15215 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15216 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15218 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15219 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15220 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015221
15222 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15223 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015224 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015225
15226 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015227 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015228
15229 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015231
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015232 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015233 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15234
15235 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15236 binary or string samples.
15237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015238 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15239 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015241 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15242 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15243 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15246 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015248 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15249 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15252 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015254 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15255 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015256 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15259 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15260 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015261
15262For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15263request, it is possible to do :
15264
15265 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15266
15267In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15268buffer, one would use the following acl :
15269
15270 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15271
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015272On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15273possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15274
15275 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015277All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15278criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15279method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15280to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15281criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15282the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015284If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015285the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15286For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15289 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15290 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15291 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015292
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015293
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015294The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15295types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15296combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15297brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15298default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300 +-------------------------------------------------+
15301 | Input sample type |
15302 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015303 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15305 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15306 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015307 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015308 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015309 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015311 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015313 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015315 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015317 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015319 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015321 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015323 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015325 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015327 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15329 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15330 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015331
15332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153337.1.1. Matching booleans
15334------------------------
15335
15336In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15337Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15338When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15339that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15340
15341Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15342return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15343"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15344
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153467.1.2. Matching integers
15347------------------------
15348
15349Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15350enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15351to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15352
15353Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15354matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15355lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015356
15357For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15358unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15359representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15360
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015361As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15362two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15363instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15364ranges and operators.
15365
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015366For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015367operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15368Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15369of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015371Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015372
15373 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15374 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15375 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15376 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15377 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015379For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015380
15381 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15382
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015383This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15384
15385 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15386
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153887.1.3. Matching strings
15389-----------------------
15390
15391String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15392different forms :
15393
15394 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015395 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015396
15397 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015398 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399
15400 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15401 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15402
15403 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15404 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15405
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015406 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015407 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15408 matches.
15409
15410 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15411 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15412 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015413
15414String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15415exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15416characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15417string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15418to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015419before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015420
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015421Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15422(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15423Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15424
15425Example:
15426 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15427 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15428
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154307.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15431---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015432
15433Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15434they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15435possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15436passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15437the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015438the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15439match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015440
15441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154427.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15443-------------------------------------
15444
15445It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15446not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15447a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15448to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15449digits may be used upper or lower case.
15450
15451Example :
15452 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15453 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15454
15455
154567.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15457---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015458
15459IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15460netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15461within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015462host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015463difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15464at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15465does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15466parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015467
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015468The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15469abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15470
15471 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15472 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15473 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15474 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15475 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15476 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15477 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15478 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15479
15480Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15481192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15482
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015483IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15484Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15485trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15486IPv6 patterns.
15487
15488HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15489following situations :
15490 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15491 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15492 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15493 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15494 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15495 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15496 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15497 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15498 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15499 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501
155027.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15503----------------------------------
15504
15505Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15506combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15507
15508 - AND (implicit)
15509 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15510 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15517indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015519For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15520"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15521requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15522is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15523
15524 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015525 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15526 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15527 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528
15529To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15530and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15531
15532 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15533 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15534 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15535 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15536
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015537 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015538 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15539 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15540 use_backend www if host_www
15541
15542It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15543expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15544be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15545the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15546
15547 The following rule :
15548
15549 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015550 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551
15552 Can also be written that way :
15553
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015554 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555
15556It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15557to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15558simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15559sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15560good use is the following :
15561
15562 With named ACLs :
15563
15564 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15565 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15566 monitor fail if site_dead
15567
15568 With anonymous ACLs :
15569
15570 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15571
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015572See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15573keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015574
15575
155767.3. Fetching samples
15577---------------------
15578
15579Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15580against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15581sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15582ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15583of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15584available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15585
15586This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15587Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15588compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15589deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15590
15591The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15592matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15593method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15594indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15595
15596As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15597when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15598mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15599the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15600ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15601
15602Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15603multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15604when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015605incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15606are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15608all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15609
15610Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15611 - name
15612 - name(arg1)
15613 - name(arg1,arg2)
15614
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015615
156167.3.1. Converters
15617-----------------
15618
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015619Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15620of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15621is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15622was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015623has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015624unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15625
15626These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15627sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15628the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015629support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015631A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15632support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15633supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15634(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15635bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015638
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001563951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15640 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15641 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15642 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15643 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15644 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15645
15646 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015647 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15648 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015649 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15650 frontend http-in
15651 bind *:8081
15652 default_backend servers
15653 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15654 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15655
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015656add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015657 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015658 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015659 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15660 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15663 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15664 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15665 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015666 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015667 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015668
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015669aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15670 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15671 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15672 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15673 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15674 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15675 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15676
15677 Example:
15678 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15679 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15680
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015681and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015682 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015683 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015684 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15685 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015686 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015687 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15688 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15689 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15690 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015691 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015692 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015693
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015694b64dec
15695 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15696 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015697 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15698 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015699
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015700base64
15701 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015702 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015703 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15704 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015705
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015706bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015707 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015708 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015709 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015710 presence of a flag).
15711
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015712bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15713 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15714 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015715 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015716
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015717concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15718 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15719 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15720 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15721 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15722 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15723 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15724 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15725 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15726 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15727 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015728 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015729 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015730 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15731 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015732
15733 Example:
15734 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15735 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15736 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015737 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015738 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15739
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015740cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015741 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15742 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015743
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015744crc32([<avalanche>])
15745 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15746 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15747 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15748 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15749 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15750 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15751 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15752 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15753 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15754 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015755 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15756
15757crc32c([<avalanche>])
15758 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15759 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15760 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15761 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15762 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15763 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15764 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15765 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015766
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015767cut_crlf
15768 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15769 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15770 updated.
15771
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015772da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015773 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15774 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15775 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15776 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015777 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015778 configuration language.
15779
15780 Example:
15781 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015782 bind *:8881
15783 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015784 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015785
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015786debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15787 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15788 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15789 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15790 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15791 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15792 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15793 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15794 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15795 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15796 printable sample types.
15797
15798 Example:
15799 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015800
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015801digest(<algorithm>)
15802 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15803 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15804
15805 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15806 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15807
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015808div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015809 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15810 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015811 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015812 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15813 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015814 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015815 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15816 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15817 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15818 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015819 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015820 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015821
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015822djb2([<avalanche>])
15823 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15824 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15825 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15826 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15827 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15828 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15829 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015830 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15831 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015832
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015833even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015834 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015835 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15836
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015837field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15838 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15839 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15840 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15841 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15842 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15843 fields.
15844
15845 Example :
15846 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15847 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15848 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15849 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15850 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015851
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015852fix_is_valid
15853 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15854 Information eXchange):
15855
15856 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15857 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015858 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015859 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010015860 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015861 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15862 checksum
15863
15864 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15865 the server can be parsed.
15866
15867 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15868 message, false if not.
15869
15870 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15871
15872 Example:
15873 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15874 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15875
15876fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15877 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15878 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15879 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15880 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050015881 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015882 added.
15883
15884 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15885 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15886 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15887 fix_is_valid converter.
15888
15889 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15890
15891 Example:
15892 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15893 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15894 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15895 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15896 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15897
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015898hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015899 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015900 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015901 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015902 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015903
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015904hex2i
15905 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015906 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015907
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015908htonl
15909 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15910 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15911 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15912 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15913
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015914hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015915 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15916 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15917 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15918 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15919
15920 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15921 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15922
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015923http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015924 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15925 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015926 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15927 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15928 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15929 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15930 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15931 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15932 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15933 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015935iif(<true>,<false>)
15936 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15937 string otherwise.
15938
15939 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015940 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015941
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015942in_table(<table>)
15943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15945 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015946 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015947 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15948
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015949ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015950 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015951 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015952 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15953 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15954 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15955 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15956 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015957
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015958json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015959 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015960 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015961 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015962 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15963 of errors:
15964 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15965 bytes, ...)
15966 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15967 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15968
15969 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15970 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15971 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15972 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15973 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15974 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015975 - "ascii" : never fails;
15976 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15977 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015978 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015979 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015980 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15981 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15982
15983 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015984 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015985
15986 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015987 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015988 capture request header user-agent len 150
15989 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015990
15991 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15992 GET / HTTP/1.0
15993 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15994
15995 Output log:
15996 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15997
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020015998json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
15999 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16000 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16001 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16002 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16003
16004 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16005 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16006
16007 Example:
16008 # get a integer value from the request body
16009 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16010 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16011
16012 # get a key with '.' in the name
16013 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16014 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16015
16016 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16017 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16018
16019 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16020 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16021
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016022language(<value>[,<default>])
16023 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16024 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16025 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16026 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16027 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16028 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16029 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16030 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16031 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016032 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016033 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16034 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016035
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016036 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016037
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016038 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16039 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016041 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16042 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16043 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16044 use_backend spanish if es
16045 use_backend french if fr
16046 use_backend english if en
16047 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016048
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016049length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016050 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16051 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16052 type. The result is of type integer.
16053
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016054lower
16055 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16056 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16057 type. The result is of type string.
16058
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016059ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16060 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16061 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16062 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16063 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16064 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16065 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16066
16067 Example :
16068
16069 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016070 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016071 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16072
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016073ltrim(<chars>)
16074 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16075 representation of the input sample.
16076
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016077map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16078map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16079map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16080 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16081 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16082 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16083 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16084 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16085 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16086 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16087 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016088
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016089 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16090 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16091 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016092
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016093 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016094 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016095
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016096 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16097 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16098 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16099 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016100 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16101 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016102 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16103 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16104 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16105 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16106 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16107 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16108 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16109 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016110 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16111 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16112 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016113 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16114 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16115 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16116 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16117 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016118
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016119 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16120 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16121 the corresponding match text.
16122
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016123 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16124 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16125 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16126 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16127 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016128
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016129 Example :
16130
16131 # this is a comment and is ignored
16132 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16133 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16134 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16135 | | | `---------- value
16136 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16137 | `---------------------------- key
16138 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16139
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016140mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016141 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16142 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016143 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016144 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016145 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016146 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16147 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16148 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16149 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016150 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016151 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016152
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016153mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
16154 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16155 <packettype>.
16156 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16157 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16158 from.
16159 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16160 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16161 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16162
16163 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16164 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16165 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16166 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16167
16168 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16169 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16170 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16171 packets only):
16172 17: Session Expiry Interval
16173 33: Receive Maximum
16174 39: Maximum Packet Size
16175 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16176 25: Request Response Information
16177 23: Request Problem Information
16178 21: Authentication Method
16179 22: Authentication Data
16180 18: Will Delay Interval
16181 1: Payload Format Indicator
16182 2: Message Expiry Interval
16183 3: Content Type
16184 8: Response Topic
16185 9: Correlation Data
16186 Not supported yet:
16187 38: User Property
16188
16189 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16190 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16191 packets only):
16192 17: Session Expiry Interval
16193 33: Receive Maximum
16194 36: Maximum QoS
16195 37: Retain Available
16196 39: Maximum Packet Size
16197 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16198 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16199 31: Reason String
16200 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16201 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16202 42: Shared Subscription Available
16203 19: Server Keep Alive
16204 26: Response Information
16205 28: Server Reference
16206 21: Authentication Method
16207 22: Authentication Data
16208 Not supported yet:
16209 38: User Property
16210
16211 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16212 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16213 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16214 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16215
16216 Example:
16217
16218 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16219 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16220 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16221 if data_in_buffer
16222 # do the same as above
16223 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16224 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16225 if data_in_buffer
16226
16227mqtt_is_valid
16228 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16229
16230 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16231 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16232 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16233 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16234
16235 Example:
16236
16237 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16238 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16239
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016240mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016241 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016242 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16243 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016244 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016245 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16248 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16249 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16250 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016251 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016252 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016253
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016254nbsrv
16255 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16256 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16257 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16258 map lookup.
16259
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016260neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016261 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16262 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16263 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16264 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016265
16266not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016267 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016268 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016269 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016270 absence of a flag).
16271
16272odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016273 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016274 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16275
16276or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016277 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016278 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016279 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16280 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016281 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016282 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16283 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16284 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16285 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016287 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016288
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016289protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16290 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16291 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16292 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16293 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16294 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16295 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16296 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16297 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16298 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16299 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16300 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16301
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016302regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016303 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16304 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16305 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16306 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16307 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16308 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16309 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16310 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16311 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016312 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16313 of characters with other ones.
16314
16315 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16316 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16317 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16318 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16319 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16320 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016321
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016322 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016323
16324 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16325 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16326 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016327 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016328
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016329 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16330 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16331
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016332 # capture groups and backreferences
16333 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016334 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016335 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16336
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016337capture-req(<id>)
16338 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16339 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16340
16341 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016342 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16343 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016344
16345capture-res(<id>)
16346 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16347 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16348
16349 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016350 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16351 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016352
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016353rtrim(<chars>)
16354 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16355 of the input sample.
16356
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016357sdbm([<avalanche>])
16358 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16359 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16360 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16361 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16362 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16363 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16364 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016365 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16366 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016367
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016368secure_memcmp(<var>)
16369 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16370 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16371 match.
16372
16373 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16374 performed in constant time.
16375
16376 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16377 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16378
16379 Example :
16380
16381 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16382 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16383 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16384 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16385
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016386set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016387 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16388 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16389 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016390 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016391 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16392 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016393 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016394 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16395 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016396 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016397 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016398
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016399sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016400 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016401 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16402
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016403sha2([<bits>])
16404 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16405 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16406
16407 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16408 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16409
16410 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16411 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16412
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016413srv_queue
16414 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16415 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16416 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16417 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16418 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16419
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016420strcmp(<var>)
16421 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16422 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16423 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16424 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16425 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16426 shorter).
16427
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016428 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16429 strings in constant time.
16430
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016431 Example :
16432
16433 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16434 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16435 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16436
16437
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016438sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016439 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16440 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016441 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016442 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16443 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016444 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016445 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16446 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016447 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016448 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16449 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016450 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016451 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016452
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016453table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16454 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16455 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16456 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16457 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16458 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16459 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16460
16461
16462table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16463 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16464 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16465 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16466 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16467 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16468 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16469
16470table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16471 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16472 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016473 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016474 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16475 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16476
16477table_conn_cur(<table>)
16478 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16479 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16480 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16481 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16482 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16483
16484table_conn_rate(<table>)
16485 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16486 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16487 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16488 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16489 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16490
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016491table_gpt0(<table>)
16492 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16493 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16494 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16495 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16496 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16497
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016498table_gpc0(<table>)
16499 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16500 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16501 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16502 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16503 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16504
16505table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16506 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16507 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16508 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16509 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16510 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16511 sample fetch keyword.
16512
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016513table_gpc1(<table>)
16514 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16515 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16516 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16517 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16518 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16519
16520table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16521 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16522 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16523 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16524 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16525 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16526 sample fetch keyword.
16527
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016528table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16529 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16530 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016531 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016532 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16533 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16534
16535table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16536 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16537 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16538 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16539 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16540 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16541 keyword.
16542
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016543table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16544 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16545 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16546 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16547 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16548 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16549
16550table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16551 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16552 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16553 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16554 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16555 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16556 keyword.
16557
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016558table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16559 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16560 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016561 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016562 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16563 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16564
16565table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16568 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16569 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16570 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16571 keyword.
16572
16573table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16574 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16575 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016576 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016577 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16578 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16579 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16580 keyword.
16581
16582table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16583 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16584 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016585 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016586 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16587 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16588 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16589 keyword.
16590
16591table_server_id(<table>)
16592 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16593 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16594 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16595 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16596 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16597 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16598
16599table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16600 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16601 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016602 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016603 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16604 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16605 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16606 keyword.
16607
16608table_sess_rate(<table>)
16609 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16610 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16611 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16612 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16613 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16614 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16615 keyword.
16616
16617table_trackers(<table>)
16618 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16619 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16620 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16621 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16622 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16623 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16624 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16625 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16626 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16627 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16628
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016629ub64dec
16630 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16631 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16632 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16633
16634 Example:
16635 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16636 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16637
16638ub64enc
16639 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16640
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016641upper
16642 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16643 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16644 type. The result is of type string.
16645
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016646url_dec([<in_form>])
16647 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16648 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16649 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16650 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16651 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16652 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016653
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016654url_enc([<enc_type>])
16655 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16656 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16657 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16658 optional argument is here for future changes.
16659
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016660ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016661 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016662 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16663 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16664 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016665 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16666 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16667 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16668 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016669 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016670 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16671 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016672
16673 Example:
16674 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16675 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16676
16677 message Point {
16678 int32 latitude = 1;
16679 int32 longitude = 2;
16680 }
16681
16682 message PPoint {
16683 Point point = 59;
16684 }
16685
16686 message Rectangle {
16687 // One corner of the rectangle.
16688 PPoint lo = 48;
16689 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16690 PPoint hi = 49;
16691 }
16692
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016693 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16694 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16695 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016696
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016697 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16698 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016699 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016700 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16701
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016702 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016703
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016704 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016705
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016706 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16707 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16708 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016709
16710 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16711 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16712 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16713
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016714 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16715 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16716 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016717
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016718
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016719unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016720 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16721 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16722 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16723 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16724 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16725 response),
16726 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16727 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16728 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16729 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16730
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016731utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16732 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16733 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16734 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16735 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16736 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16737 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16738
16739 Example :
16740
16741 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016742 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016743 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16744
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016745word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16746 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16747 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16748 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016749 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016750 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16751 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16752
16753 Example :
16754 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16755 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16756 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16757 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16758 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016759 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016760
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016761wt6([<avalanche>])
16762 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16763 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16764 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16765 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16766 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16767 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16768 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016769 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16770 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016771
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016772xor(<value>)
16773 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016774 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016775 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016776 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016777 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016778 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16779 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016780 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016781 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16782 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016783 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016784 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016785
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016786xxh3([<seed>])
16787 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16788 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16789 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16790 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16791 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16792 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16793 considered as cryptographically secure.
16794
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016795xxh32([<seed>])
16796 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16797 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16798 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16799 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16800 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16801 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16802 as cryptographically secure.
16803
16804xxh64([<seed>])
16805 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16806 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16807 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16808 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16809 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16810 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16811 as cryptographically secure.
16812
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016813
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168147.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815--------------------------------------------
16816
16817A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16818not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16819"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16820The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16821
16822always_false : boolean
16823 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16824 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16825
16826always_true : boolean
16827 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16828 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16829
16830avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016831 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16833 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16834 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16835 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16836 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16837 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16838 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16839 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16840 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16841 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16842 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16843 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16844 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016846be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016847 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16848 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16849 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16850 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016851 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16852
16853be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16854 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16855 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16856 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16857 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16858 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016859 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16860 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016861
16862 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16863 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16864 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016866be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16867 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16868 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16869 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016870 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016871 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16872 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016873
16874 Example :
16875 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16876 backend dynamic
16877 mode http
16878 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16879 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016880
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016881bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016882 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16883 of the string.
16884
16885bool(<bool>) : bool
16886 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16887 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16890 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016891 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16893 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016894
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016895 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016896 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016897 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16898
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016899 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16900 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016901
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016902 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016903 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016905 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016906 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016907 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016908 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016909
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016910 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16911 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016912 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016913 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016914
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016915cpu_calls : integer
16916 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16917 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16918 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16919 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16920 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16921 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16922
16923cpu_ns_avg : integer
16924 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16925 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16926 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16927 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16928 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16929 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16930 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16931 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16932 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16933 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16934 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16935
16936cpu_ns_tot : integer
16937 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16938 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16939 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16940 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16941 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16942 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16943 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16944 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16945 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16946 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16947 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16948 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16949 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16950
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016951date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016952 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016953
16954 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16955 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16956 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016957 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16958
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016959 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16960 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16961 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16962 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16963 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16964
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016965 Example :
16966
16967 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16968 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016969
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016970 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16971 # millisecond granularity
16972 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16973
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016974date_us : integer
16975 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16976 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16977 from the same timeval structure.
16978
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016979distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16980 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16981 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16982 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16983 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16984 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16985 list of supported tokens.
16986
16987distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16988 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16989 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16990 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16991 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16992 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16993 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16994 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16995 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16996 supported tokens.
16997
16998 Example :
16999 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17000 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17001 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17002 # send large files to the big farm
17003 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17004
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017005env(<name>) : string
17006 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17007 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17008 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17009 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17010 certain way.
17011
17012 Examples :
17013 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17014 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17015
17016 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17017 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017019fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17020 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017021 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17022 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017023 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17024 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017025 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017026 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17027 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017028
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017029fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17030 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17031 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17032 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017034fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17035 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17036 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17037 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17038 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17039 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17040 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17041 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17042 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017043
17044 Example :
17045 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17046 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17047 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17048 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17049 frontend mail
17050 bind :25
17051 mode tcp
17052 maxconn 100
17053 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17054 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17055 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17056 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017057
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017058hostname : string
17059 Returns the system hostname.
17060
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017061int(<integer>) : signed integer
17062 Returns a signed integer.
17063
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017064ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17065 Returns an ipv4.
17066
17067ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17068 Returns an ipv6.
17069
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017070lat_ns_avg : integer
17071 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17072 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17073 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17074 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17075 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17076 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17077 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17078 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17079 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017080 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17081 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17082 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17083 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17084 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17085 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017086
17087lat_ns_tot : integer
17088 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17089 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17090 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17091 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17092 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17093 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17094 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17095 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17096 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017097 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17098 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17099 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17100 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17101 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017102 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17103 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17104 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17105 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17106 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17107 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17108
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017109meth(<method>) : method
17110 Returns a method.
17111
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017112nbproc : integer
17113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17114 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17115 and debugging purposes.
17116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17119 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17120 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017121 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17122 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17123 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017124
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017125prio_class : integer
17126 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17127 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17128 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17129
17130prio_offset : integer
17131 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17132 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17133 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17134 set-priority-offset".
17135
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017136proc : integer
17137 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17138 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17139 debugging purposes.
17140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017141queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017142 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17143 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17144 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017145 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17146 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17147 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17148 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17149 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17150
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017151rand([<range>]) : integer
17152 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17153 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17154 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17155 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17156 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17157
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017158uuid([<version>]) : string
17159 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17160 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17161 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017163srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17165 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17166 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17167 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17168 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017169 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17170 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17171
17172srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17173 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17174 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17175 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17176 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17177 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17178 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17179 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17180
17181 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17182 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017183
17184srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17185 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17186 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17187 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017188 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017189 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17190 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17191 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17192
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017193srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17194 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17195 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17196 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17197 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17198 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17199 fetch methods.
17200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017201srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17202 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17203 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017204 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17206 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017207 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017208 overloading servers).
17209
17210 Example :
17211 # Redirect to a separate back
17212 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17213 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17214 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17215
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017216srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17217 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17218 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17219 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17220
17221srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17222 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17223 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17224 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17225
17226srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17227 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17228 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17229 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17230
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017231stopping : boolean
17232 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17233 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17234 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17235
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017236str(<string>) : string
17237 Returns a string.
17238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17240 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17241 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17242
17243table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17244 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17245 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17246 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17247
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017248thread : integer
17249 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17250 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17251 and debugging purposes.
17252
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017253var(<var-name>) : undefined
17254 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017255 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17256 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017257 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017258 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17259 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017260 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017261 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17262 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017263 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017264 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017265
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172667.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267----------------------------------
17268
17269The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17270closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17271methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17272sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17273TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017274the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17275counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017276"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17277used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17278can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17279Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17280table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17281tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17282currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017283
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017284bc_dst : ip
17285 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17286 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17287 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17288 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17289
17290bc_dst_port : integer
17291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17292 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17293
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017294bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017295 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17296 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17297 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17298
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017299bc_src : ip
17300 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17301 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17302 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17303 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17304
17305bc_src_port : integer
17306 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17307 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017309be_id : integer
17310 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017311 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17312 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017314be_name : string
17315 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017316 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17317 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017318
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017319be_server_timeout : integer
17320 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17321 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17322 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17323
17324be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17325 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17326 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17327 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17328
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017329cur_server_timeout : integer
17330 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17331 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17332 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17333
17334cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17335 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17336 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17337 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017339dst : ip
17340 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17341 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17342 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17343 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017344 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17345 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17346 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17347 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17348 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17349 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017350
17351dst_conn : integer
17352 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17353 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17354 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17355 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17356 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17357 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17358 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17359 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017360
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017361dst_is_local : boolean
17362 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17363 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17364 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17365 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017366 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017367 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17368 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17369 it only once per connection.
17370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371dst_port : integer
17372 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17373 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17374 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17375 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17376 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17377 an HTTP header.
17378
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017379fc_http_major : integer
17380 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17381 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17382 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17383
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017384fc_pp_authority : string
17385 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17386 if any.
17387
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017388fc_pp_unique_id : string
17389 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17390 if any.
17391
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017392fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17393 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17394 header.
17395
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017396fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17397 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17398 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17399 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17400 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17401 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17402 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17403
17404fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17405 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17406 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17407 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17408 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17409 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17410 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17411
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017412fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017413 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17414 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17415 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17416 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17417
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017418fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017419 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17420 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17421 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17422 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17423
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017424fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017425 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17426 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17427 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17428 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17429
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017430fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017431 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17432 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17433 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17434 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17435
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017436fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017437 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17438 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17439 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17440 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17441
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017442fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017443 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17444 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17445 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17446 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17447
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017448fe_defbe : string
17449 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17450 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017452fe_id : integer
17453 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017454 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017455 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17456
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017457fe_name : string
17458 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17459 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17460 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17461
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017462fe_client_timeout : integer
17463 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17464 current frontend.
17465
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017466sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017467sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17468sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17469sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017470 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17471 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17472 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017474sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017475sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17476sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17477sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017478 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17479 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17480 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17481
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017482sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017483sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17484sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17485sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017486 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17487 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017488 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17489 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17490 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017491
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017492 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017493 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17494 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017495 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17496 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17497 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017498 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17499 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17500
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017501sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17502sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17503sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17504sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17505 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17506 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17507 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17508 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17509 when a first ACL was verified.
17510
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017511sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017512sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17513sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17514sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017515 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017516 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017518sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017519sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17520sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17521sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017522 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17523 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17524 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017526sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017527sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17528sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17529sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017530 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17531 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17532 See also src_conn_rate.
17533
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017534sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017535sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17536sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17537sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017538 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017539 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017540
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017541sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17542sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17543sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17544sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17545 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17546 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17547
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017548sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17549sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17550sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17551sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17552 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17553 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17554
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017555sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017556sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17557sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17558sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017559 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17560 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17561 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017562 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17563 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17564 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017565
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017566sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17567sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17568sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17569sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17570 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17571 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17572 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17573 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17574 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17575 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17576
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017577sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017578sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17579sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17580sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017581 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017582 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17583 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17584
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017585sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017586sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17587sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17588sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017589 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17590 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17591 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17592 src_http_err_rate.
17593
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017594sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17595sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17596sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17597sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17598 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17599 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17600 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17601
17602sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17603sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17604sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17605sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17606 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17607 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17608 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17609 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017611sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017612sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17613sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17614sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017615 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017616 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17617 src_http_req_cnt.
17618
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017619sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017620sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17621sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17622sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017623 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17624 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17625 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17626 src_http_req_rate.
17627
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017628sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017629sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17630sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17631sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017632 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017633 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17634 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17635 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17636 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017637
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017638 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017639 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17640 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017641 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17642
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017643sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17644sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17645sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17646sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17647 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17648 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17649 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17650 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17651 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17652
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017653sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017654sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17655sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17656sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017657 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17658 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17659 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017661sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017662sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17663sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17664sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017665 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17666 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17667 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017668
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017669sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017670sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17671sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17672sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017673 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017674 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17675 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17676 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017677 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017678 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017680sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017681sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17682sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17683sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017684 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17685 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17686 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17687 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17688 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017689 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017691sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017692sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17693sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17694sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017695 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17696 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17697 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017699sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017700sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17701sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17702sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017703 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17704 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017705 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017706 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17707 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017708 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17709 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17710 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017712so_id : integer
17713 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17714 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17715 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017716
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017717so_name : string
17718 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17719 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17720 strings instead of integers.
17721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017722src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017723 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017724 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17725 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17726 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017727 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17728 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17729 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017730 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17731 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17732 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17733 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17734 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17735 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17736 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017737
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017738 Example:
17739 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17740 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017742src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17743 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17744 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17745 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017746 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017748src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17749 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17750 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017751 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017752 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017754src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17755 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17756 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17757 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17758 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17759 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17760 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017761
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017762 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017763 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17764 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17765 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17766 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017767 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017768 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17769 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17770
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017771src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17772 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17773 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17774 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17775 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17776 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17777 was verified.
17778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017780 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017782 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017783 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017785src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017786 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017787 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17788 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017789 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017791src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17792 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17793 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17794 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017795 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017797src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017798 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017799 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017800 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017801 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017802
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017803src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17804 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17805 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17806 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17807 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17808
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017809src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17810 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17811 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17812 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17813 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017815src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017816 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017818 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17819 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017820 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17821 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17822 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017823
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017824src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17825 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17826 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17827 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17828 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17829 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17830 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17831 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017833src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017834 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017835 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017836 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017837 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017838 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017840src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17841 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17842 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17843 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17844 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017845 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017846
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017847src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17848 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17849 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050017850 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017851 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17852 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17853
17854src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17855 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17856 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17857 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17858 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17859 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17860 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017862src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017863 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017864 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17865 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017866 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017868src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17869 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17870 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17871 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017872 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017873 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017875src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17876 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17877 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17878 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017879 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017880 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17881 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017882
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017883 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017884 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017885 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017886 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017887
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017888src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17889 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17890 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17891 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17892 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17893 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17894 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17895
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017896src_is_local : boolean
17897 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17898 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17899 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17900 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017901 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017902 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17903 once per connection.
17904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017905src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017906 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17907 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17908 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17909 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17910 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017912src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017913 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17914 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17915 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17916 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17917 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017919src_port : integer
17920 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17921 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17922 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17923 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017925src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017926 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017927 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17928 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17929 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017930 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017932src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17933 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17934 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17935 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17936 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017937 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017939src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17940 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17941 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17942 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17943 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17944 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17945 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17946 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17947 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017948
17949 Example :
17950 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17951 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17952 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17953 listen ssh
17954 bind :22
17955 mode tcp
17956 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017957 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017958 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017959 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017961srv_id : integer
17962 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17963 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017964 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017965
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017966srv_name : string
17967 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17968 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017969 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017970
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179717.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017972----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017974The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17975closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17976when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17977usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017978future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017979
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001798051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17981 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17982 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17983 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17984 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17985 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17986
17987 Example :
17988 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17989 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17990 # the request.
17991 frontend http-in
17992 bind *:8081
17993 default_backend servers
17994 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17995 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17996
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017997ssl_bc : boolean
17998 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17999 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018000 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18001 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018002
18003ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18004 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018005 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18006 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018007
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018008ssl_bc_alpn : string
18009 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18010 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018011 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018012 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18013 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18014 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18015 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18016 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018017 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18018 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018019
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018020ssl_bc_cipher : string
18021 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018022 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18023 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018024
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018025ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18026 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18027 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18028 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018029 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018030
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018031ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18032 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18033 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018034 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18035 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018036
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018037ssl_bc_npn : string
18038 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18039 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018040 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018041 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18042 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18043 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18044 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018045 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18046 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018047
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018048ssl_bc_protocol : string
18049 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018050 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18051 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018052
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018053ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018054 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018055 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018056 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18057 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018058
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018059ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18060 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18061 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18062 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018063 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018064
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018065ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18066 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18067 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018068 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18069 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018070
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018071ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18072 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18073 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18074 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018075 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018076
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018077ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18078 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018079 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18080 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018082ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18083 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18084 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18085 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18086 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18087 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018089ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18090 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18091 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18092 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18093 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018094
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018095ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018096 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18097 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18098 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018099 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018100 does not support resumed sessions.
18101
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018102ssl_c_der : binary
18103 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18104 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18105 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107ssl_c_err : integer
18108 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18109 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18110 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18111 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18112 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018113
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018114ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018115 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18116 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18117 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18118 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18119 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18120 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18121 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18122 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018123 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18124 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18125 LDAP v3.
18126 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18127 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018129ssl_c_key_alg : string
18130 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18131 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18132 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018134ssl_c_notafter : string
18135 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18136 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18137 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018139ssl_c_notbefore : string
18140 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18141 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18142 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018143
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018144ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018145 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18146 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18147 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18148 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18149 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18150 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18151 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18152 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018153 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18154 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18155 LDAP v3.
18156 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18157 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018159ssl_c_serial : binary
18160 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18161 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18162 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018164ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18165 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18166 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18167 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018168 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18169 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18170
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018171 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018172 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018174ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18175 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18176 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18177 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179ssl_c_used : boolean
18180 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18181 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018183ssl_c_verify : integer
18184 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18185 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18186 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18187 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018189ssl_c_version : integer
18190 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18191 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018192
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018193ssl_f_der : binary
18194 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18195 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18196 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18197
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018198ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018199 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18200 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18201 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18202 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018203 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18205 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18206 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018207 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18208 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18209 LDAP v3.
18210 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18211 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018213ssl_f_key_alg : string
18214 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18215 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18216 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018218ssl_f_notafter : string
18219 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18220 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18221 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223ssl_f_notbefore : string
18224 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18225 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18226 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018227
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018228ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18230 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18231 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18232 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18233 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18234 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18235 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18236 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018237 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18238 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18239 LDAP v3.
18240 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18241 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243ssl_f_serial : binary
18244 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18245 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18246 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018247
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018248ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18249 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18250 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18251 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018253ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18254 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18255 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18256 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018258ssl_f_version : integer
18259 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18260 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18261
18262ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018263 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18264 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18265 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018267 Example :
18268 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18269 listen http-https
18270 bind :80
18271 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18272 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18273
18274ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18275 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18276 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18277
18278ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018279 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18281 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18282 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18283 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18284 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18285 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18286 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18287 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018289ssl_fc_cipher : string
18290 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18291 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018292
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018293ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18294 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18295 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018296 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018297
18298ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18299 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18300 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018301 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018302
18303ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18304 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18305 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18306 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018307 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018308 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018309
18310ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18311 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18312 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018313 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018314
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018315ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18316 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18317 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18318 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18319
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018320ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18321 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18322 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18323 transport layer.
18324 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18325 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18326 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18327 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18328
18329ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18330 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18331 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18332 transport layer.
18333 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18334 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18335 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18336 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18337
18338ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18339 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18340 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18341 transport layer.
18342 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18343 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18344 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18345 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18346
18347ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18348 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18349 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18350 transport layer.
18351 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18352 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18353 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18354 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18355
18356ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18357 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18358 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18359 transport layer.
18360 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18361 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18362 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18363 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018365ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018366 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18367 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018368 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18369 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18370 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18371 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018372
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018373ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18374 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18375 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18376 wait until the handshake happened.
18377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18379 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018380 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18381 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018382 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018383 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018384
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018385ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018386 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018387 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18388 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018390ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018391 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018392 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18393 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18394 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18395 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18396 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18397 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18398 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018400ssl_fc_protocol : string
18401 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18402 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018403
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018404ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018405 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018406 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18407 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018408
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018409ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18410 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18411 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18412 transport layer.
18413 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18414 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18415 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18416 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18417
18418ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18419 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18420 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18421 transport layer.
18422 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18423 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18424 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18425 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18426
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018427ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18428 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18429 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18430 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18433 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18434 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18435 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18436 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018437
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018438ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18439 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18440 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18441 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18442 BoringSSL.
18443
18444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018445ssl_fc_sni : string
18446 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18447 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18448 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18449 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18450 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18451
18452 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18453 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18454 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018455 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018456 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018458 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018459 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18460 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018462ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18463 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18464 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018465
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018466ssl_s_der : binary
18467 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18468 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18469 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18470
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018471ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18472 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18473 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18474 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018475 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018476 does not support resumed sessions.
18477
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018478ssl_s_key_alg : string
18479 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18480 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18481 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18482
18483ssl_s_notafter : string
18484 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18485 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18486 transport layer.
18487
18488ssl_s_notbefore : string
18489 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18490 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18491 transport layer.
18492
18493ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18494 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18495 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18496 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18497 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18498 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18499 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018500 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18501 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018502 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18503 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18504 LDAP v3.
18505 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18506 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18507
18508ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18509 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18510 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18511 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18512 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18513 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18514 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018515 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18516 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018517 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18518 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18519 LDAP v3.
18520 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18521 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18522
18523ssl_s_serial : binary
18524 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18525 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18526 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18527
18528ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18529 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18530 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18531 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18532
18533ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18534 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18535 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18536 layer.
18537
18538ssl_s_version : integer
18539 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18540 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018541
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185427.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018543------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18546sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18547only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18548For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18549be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18550can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18551sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18552for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18553content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018554
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018555Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18556 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18557 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18558 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18559 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18560 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18561 sample expression). So be careful.
18562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018563payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018564 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18566 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018568payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18569 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018570 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018571 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018573req.len : integer
18574req_len : integer (deprecated)
18575 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18576 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18577 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18578 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18579 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18580 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18581 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18582 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018584req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18585 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018586 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18587 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18588 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18589 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018591 ACL alternatives :
18592 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018594req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18595 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18596 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18597 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18598 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018600 ACL alternatives :
18601 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018603 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018605req.proto_http : boolean
18606req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18607 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18608 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18609 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18610 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18611 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18612 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18613 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018615 Example:
18616 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18617 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18618 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018619 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018621req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18622rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18623 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18624 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18625 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18626 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18627 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18628 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18629 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018631 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18632 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18633 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18634 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18635 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18636 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018638 ACL derivatives :
18639 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018641 Example :
18642 listen tse-farm
18643 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18644 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18645 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18646 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18647 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18648 persist rdp-cookie
18649 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18650 # This is only useful makes sense if
18651 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18652 stick-table type string size 204800
18653 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18654 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18655 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018657 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18658 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018660req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18661rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18662 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18663 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18664 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18665 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018667 ACL derivatives :
18668 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018669
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018670req.ssl_alpn : string
18671 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18672 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18673 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18674 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18675 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18676 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018677 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018678
18679 Examples :
18680 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18681 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18682 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018683 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018684 default_backend bk_default
18685
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018686req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18687 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18688 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018689 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18690 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18691 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18692 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18693 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018695req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18696req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18697 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18698 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18699 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18700 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18701 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18702 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18703 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705req.ssl_sni : string
18706req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18707 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18708 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18709 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18710 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18711 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018712 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18713 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18714 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18715 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18716 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18717 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18718 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18719 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18720 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018721
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018722 ACL derivatives :
18723 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018725 Examples :
18726 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18727 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18728 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18729 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18730 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018731
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018732req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18733 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18734 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18735 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18736 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18737 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18738 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18739 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18740 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18741 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018743req.ssl_ver : integer
18744req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18745 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18746 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18747 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18748 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18749 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18750 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18751 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018752 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018755 ACL derivatives :
18756 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018757
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018758res.len : integer
18759 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18760 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18761 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18762 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18763 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18764 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18765 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018766 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18769 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018770 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018771 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018772 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018773 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018775res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18776 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18777 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18778 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018779 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18780 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018782 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018783
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018784res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18785rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18786 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18787 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18788 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18789 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18790 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18791 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18792 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018794wait_end : boolean
18795 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18796 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018797 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018798 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18799 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018800 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018801 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18802 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018804 Examples :
18805 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18806 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18807 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018809 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18810 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18811 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18812 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18813 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18814 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18815 tcp-request content reject
18816
18817
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188187.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018819--------------------------------------
18820
18821It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18822This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18823data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18824its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18825HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18826content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18827to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18828more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18829response are indexed.
18830
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010018831Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
18832 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
18833 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
18834 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
18835 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
18836 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
18837 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
18838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018839base : string
18840 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18841 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18842 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18843 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18844 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18845 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18846 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18847 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18848
18849 ACL derivatives :
18850 base : exact string match
18851 base_beg : prefix match
18852 base_dir : subdir match
18853 base_dom : domain match
18854 base_end : suffix match
18855 base_len : length match
18856 base_reg : regex match
18857 base_sub : substring match
18858
18859base32 : integer
18860 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18861 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18862 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018863 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18864 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18865 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018866
18867base32+src : binary
18868 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18869 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18870 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18871 per-URL counters.
18872
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018873baseq : string
18874 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18875 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18876 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18877 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18878
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018879capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18880 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18881 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18882 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18883
18884capture.req.method : string
18885 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18886 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18887 because it's allocated.
18888
18889capture.req.uri : string
18890 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18891 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18892 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18893 allocated.
18894
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018895capture.req.ver : string
18896 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18897 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18898 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18899
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018900capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18901 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18902 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18903 The first entry is an index of 0.
18904 See also: "capture response header"
18905
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018906capture.res.ver : string
18907 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18908 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18909 persistent flag.
18910
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018911req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018912 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18913 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18914 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018915
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018916req.body_param([<name>) : string
18917 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18918 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18919 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18920 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18921 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18922 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18923 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18924 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18925 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18926 given.
18927
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018928req.body_len : integer
18929 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18930 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018931 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18932 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018933
18934req.body_size : integer
18935 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018936 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18937 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018939req.cook([<name>]) : string
18940cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18941 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18942 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18943 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18944 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18945 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18946 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18947 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18948 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18949
18950 ACL derivatives :
18951 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18952 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18953 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18954 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18955 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18956 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18957 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18958 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018960req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18961cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18962 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18963 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018965req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18966cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18967 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18968 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18969 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18970 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018972cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18973 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18974 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18975 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18976 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018977 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18979 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18980 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18981 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018983hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18984 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18985 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18986 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18987 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018988 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018990req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018991 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18992 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18993 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18994 with headers such as User-Agent.
18995
18996 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18997 found.
18998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018999 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19000 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19001 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019002 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019004req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19005 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19006 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019007 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19008 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019010req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019011 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19012 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19013 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19014 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19015 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19016 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19017 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19018
19019 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19020 found.
19021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19023 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19024 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019025 with -1 being the last one.
19026
19027 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19028 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019030 ACL derivatives :
19031 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19032 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19033 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19034 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19035 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19036 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19037 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19038 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19039
19040req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19041hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19042 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19043 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019044 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19045 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19046 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19047
19048 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19049 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19050 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19051
19052 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053
19054req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19055hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19056 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19057 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19058 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019059 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19060 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19061 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19062 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19063 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019064
19065 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19066
19067 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019068
19069req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19070hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19071 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19072 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19073 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019074
19075 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19076
19077 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019078
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019079req.hdrs : string
19080 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19081 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19082 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19083 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19084
19085req.hdrs_bin : binary
19086 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19087 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19088 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19089 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19090 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19091 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19092
19093 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019094
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019095 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19096 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019098http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19099 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19100 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19101 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19102 basic auth is supported.
19103
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019104http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19105 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19106 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19107 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19108 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19110 basic auth is supported.
19111
19112 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019113 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19114 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19115 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19116 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019117
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019118http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019119 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19120 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19121 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019122
19123http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019124 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19125 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19126 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019127
19128http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019129 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19130 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19131 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019133http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019134 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19135 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19137 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019139method : integer + string
19140 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19141 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19142 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19143 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19144 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19145 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19146 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148 ACL derivatives :
19149 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019151 Example :
19152 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19153 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19154 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019156path : string
19157 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19158 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19159 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19160 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19161 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019162 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019163 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019165 ACL derivatives :
19166 path : exact string match
19167 path_beg : prefix match
19168 path_dir : subdir match
19169 path_dom : domain match
19170 path_end : suffix match
19171 path_len : length match
19172 path_reg : regex match
19173 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019174
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019175pathq : string
19176 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19177 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19178 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19179 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19180 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19181 result in both cases.
19182
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019183query : string
19184 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19185 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19186 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19187 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019188 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019189 which stops before the question mark.
19190
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019191req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19192 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19193 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19194 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19195 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019197req.ver : string
19198req_ver : string (deprecated)
19199 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19200 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19201 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203 ACL derivatives :
19204 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019205
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019206res.body : binary
19207 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19208 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019209 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19210
19211 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019212
19213res.body_len : integer
19214 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19215 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019216 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19217
19218 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019219
19220res.body_size : integer
19221 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19222 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19223 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19224 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019225 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19226
19227 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019228
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019229res.cache_hit : boolean
19230 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19231 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19232
19233res.cache_name : string
19234 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19235 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19236 empty string.
19237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238res.comp : boolean
19239 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19240 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19241 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019243res.comp_algo : string
19244 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19245 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19246 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248res.cook([<name>]) : string
19249scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19250 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19251 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019252 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19253
19254 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019256 ACL derivatives :
19257 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19260scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19261 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19262 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019263 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19264
19265 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019267res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19268scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19269 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19270 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019271 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19272
19273 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019275res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019276 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19277 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19278
19279 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19280 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19281
19282 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19283
19284 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019286res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019287 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19288 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19289
19290 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19291 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19292
19293 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019295res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19296shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019297 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19298 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19299
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019300 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019301 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19302
19303 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019305 ACL derivatives :
19306 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19307 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19308 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19309 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19310 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19311 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19312 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19313 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19314
19315res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19316shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019317 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19318 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19319
19320 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019321 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019322
19323 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019325res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19326shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019327 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19328 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19329
19330 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19331
19332 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019333
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019334res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19335 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19336 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19337 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019338 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19339
19340 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019342res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19343shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019344 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19345 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19346
19347 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19348
19349 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019350
19351res.hdrs : string
19352 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19353 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19354 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019355 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19356
19357 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019358
19359res.hdrs_bin : binary
19360 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19361 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19362 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19363 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19364 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19365 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19366 (length of 0 for both).
19367
19368 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19369
19370 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19371 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019373res.ver : string
19374resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19375 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019376 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19377
19378 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380 ACL derivatives :
19381 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19384 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19385 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019386 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019387 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019389 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19390 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019392status : integer
19393 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19394 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019395 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19396
19397 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019398
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019399unique-id : string
19400 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19401 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19402 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19403 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19404 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19405 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019407url : string
19408 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19409 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19410 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19411 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19412 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19413 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19414 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019416 ACL derivatives :
19417 url : exact string match
19418 url_beg : prefix match
19419 url_dir : subdir match
19420 url_dom : domain match
19421 url_end : suffix match
19422 url_len : length match
19423 url_reg : regex match
19424 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019426url_ip : ip
19427 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19428 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19429 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19430 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19431 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19432 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19433 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435url_port : integer
19436 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19437 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19438 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19439 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019440
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019441urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19442url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019443 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19444 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019445 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19446 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19447 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19448 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019449 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19450 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019451 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19452 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019454 ACL derivatives :
19455 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19456 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19457 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19458 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19459 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19460 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19461 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19462 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019463
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019465 Example :
19466 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19467 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19468 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19469 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019470
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019471urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019472 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19473 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19474 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019475
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019476url32 : integer
19477 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19478 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19479 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19480 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19481 is an unsigned integer.
19482
19483url32+src : binary
19484 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19485 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19486 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19487
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019488
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200194897.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019490---------------------------------------
19491
19492This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19493used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19494purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19495There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19496or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19497any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19498for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19499
19500internal.htx.data : integer
19501 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19502 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19503
19504internal.htx.free : integer
19505 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19506 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19507
19508internal.htx.free_data : integer
19509 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19510 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19511
19512internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019513 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19514 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19515 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019516
19517internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19518 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19519 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19520
19521internal.htx.size : integer
19522 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19523 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19524
19525internal.htx.used : integer
19526 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19527 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19528 direction.
19529
19530internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19531 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19532 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19533 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19534 of the special value :
19535 * head : The oldest inserted block
19536 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019537 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019538
19539internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19540 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19541 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19542 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19543 integer or one of the special value :
19544 * head : The oldest inserted block
19545 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019546 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019547
19548internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19549 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19550 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19551 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19552 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19553
19554 * head : The oldest inserted block
19555 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019556 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019557
19558internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19559 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19560 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19561 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19562 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19563
19564 * head : The oldest inserted block
19565 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019566 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019567
19568internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19569 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19570 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19571 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19572 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19573
19574 * head : The oldest inserted block
19575 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019576 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019577
19578internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19579 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19580 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19581 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19582 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19583
19584 * head : The oldest inserted block
19585 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019586 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019587
19588internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19589 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19590 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19591 it returns false.
19592
19593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200195947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019595---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019596
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019597Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19598every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019599order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019601ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019602---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19603FALSE always_false never match
19604HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19605HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19606HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019607HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019608HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19609HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19610HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19611HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19612LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19613METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19614METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19615METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19616METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19617METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19618METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19619METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19620METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19621RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19622REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19623TRUE always_true always match
19624WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19625---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019626
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196288. Logging
19629----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019630
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019631One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19632provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19633very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19634provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19635state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019636to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019637headers.
19638
19639In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19640about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19641send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19642
19643 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19644 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19645 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19646 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19647 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019648 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019649 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019650
19651The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19652allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19653as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19654while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19655real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19656delay.
19657
19658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196598.1. Log levels
19660---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019661
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019662TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019663source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019664HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19665in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19666track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19667syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19668about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019669
19670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196718.2. Log formats
19672----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019673
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019674HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019675and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19676slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19677options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019678
19679 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19680 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19681 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19682 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19683 extents.
19684
19685 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19686 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19687 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19688 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19689 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19690
19691 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19692 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19693 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19694 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19695 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19696
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019697 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19698 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19699 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19700 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19701
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019702 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19703
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019704Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19705specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19706field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19707servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19708always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19709identifier.
19710
19711Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19712 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19713 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19714 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19715 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19716
19717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197188.2.1. Default log format
19719-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019720
19721This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19722as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19723format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19724
19725 Example :
19726 listen www
19727 mode http
19728 log global
19729 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19730
19731 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19732 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19733 (www/HTTP)
19734
19735 Field Format Extract from the example above
19736 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19737 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19738 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19739 4 'to' to
19740 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19741 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19742
19743Detailed fields description :
19744 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19745 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19746 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19747 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19748 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19749 and processed the connection.
19750 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19751
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019752In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19753"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19754connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19755
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019756It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19757will eventually disappear.
19758
19759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197608.2.2. TCP log format
19761---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019762
19763The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19764is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19765information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19766counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19767emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19768environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19769the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19770sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019771specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19772not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19773fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19774marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019775
19776 Example :
19777 frontend fnt
19778 mode tcp
19779 option tcplog
19780 log global
19781 default_backend bck
19782
19783 backend bck
19784 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19785
19786 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19787 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19788 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19789
19790 Field Format Extract from the example above
19791 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19792 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19793 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19794 4 frontend_name fnt
19795 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19796 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19797 7 bytes_read* 212
19798 8 termination_state --
19799 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19800 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19801
19802Detailed fields description :
19803 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019804 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19805 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19806 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019807 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019808 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019809 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019810
19811 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019812 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19813 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19814 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019815
19816 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19817 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19818 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019819 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19820 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19821 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19822 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019823
19824 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19825 and processed the connection.
19826
19827 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19828 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19829 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19830 applications.
19831
19832 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19833 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19834 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19835 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19836 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19837
19838 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19839 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19840 See "Timers" below for more details.
19841
19842 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19843 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19844 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19845 "Timers" below for more details.
19846
19847 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019848 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019849 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19850 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19851 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19852 details.
19853
19854 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19855 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19856 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19857 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19858 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19859
19860 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19861 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19862 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19863 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19864 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19865 for more details.
19866
19867 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019868 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019869 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19870 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19871 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019872 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019873
19874 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19875 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19876 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19877 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19878 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19879 caused by a denial of service attack.
19880
19881 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19882 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19883 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19884 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19885 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19886 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19887 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19888 denial of service attack.
19889
19890 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19891 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19892 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19893 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19894 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19895 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19896 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19897 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19898 be processed than on other servers.
19899
19900 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19901 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19902 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19903 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19904 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19905 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19906 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19907 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19908 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19909 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19910 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19911 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19912 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19913
19914 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19915 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19916 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19917 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19918 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19919 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019920 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019921 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19922
19923 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19924 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19925 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19926 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19927 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19928 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019929 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019930 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19931 occurs.
19932
19933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199348.2.3. HTTP log format
19935----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019936
19937The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19938is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19939the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19940are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19941emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19942generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19943"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19944which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019945frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19946is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019947
19948Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19949slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19950with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19951
19952 Example :
19953 frontend http-in
19954 mode http
19955 option httplog
19956 log global
19957 default_backend bck
19958
19959 backend static
19960 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19961
19962 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19963 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19964 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019965 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019966
19967 Field Format Extract from the example above
19968 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19969 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019970 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019971 4 frontend_name http-in
19972 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019973 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019974 7 status_code 200
19975 8 bytes_read* 2750
19976 9 captured_request_cookie -
19977 10 captured_response_cookie -
19978 11 termination_state ----
19979 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19980 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19981 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19982 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19983 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019984
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019985Detailed fields description :
19986 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019987 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19988 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19989 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019990 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019991 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019992 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019993
19994 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019995 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19996 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19997 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019998
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019999 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20000 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020001
20002 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20003 and processed the connection.
20004
20005 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20006 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20007 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20008
20009 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20010 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20011 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20012 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20013 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20014 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20015
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020016 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20017 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20018 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020019 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020020 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20021 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020022 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20023 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020024
20025 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20026 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020027 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020028
20029 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20030 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020031 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20032 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020033
20034 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20035 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20036 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20037 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20038 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020039 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20040 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020041
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020042 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20043 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20044 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20045 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20046 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20047 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20048 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020049 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020050
20051 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20052 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20053 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20054
20055 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20056 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020057 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020058 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20059 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20060 overflowing.
20061
20062 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20063 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20064 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20065 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20066 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20067 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20068 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20069 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20070
20071 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20072 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20073 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20074 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20075 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20076 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20077 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20078 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20079
20080 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20081 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20082 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20083 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20084 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20085 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20086 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20087
20088 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020089 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020090 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20091 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20092 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020093 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020094 system.
20095
20096 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20097 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20098 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20099 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20100 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20101 caused by a denial of service attack.
20102
20103 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20104 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20105 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20106 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20107 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20108 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20109 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20110 denial of service attack.
20111
20112 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20113 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20114 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20115 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20116 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20117 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20118 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20119 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20120 processed than on other servers.
20121
20122 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20123 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20124 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20125 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20126 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20127 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20128 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20129 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20130 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20131 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20132 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20133 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20134 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20135
20136 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20137 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20138 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20139 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20140 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20141 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020142 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020143 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20144
20145 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20146 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20147 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20148 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20149 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20150 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020151 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020152 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20153 occurs.
20154
20155 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20156 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20157 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20158 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20159 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20160 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20161 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20162 cookies" below for more details.
20163
20164 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20165 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20166 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20167 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20168 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20169 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20170 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20171 and cookies" below for more details.
20172
20173 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20174 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20175 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20176 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20177 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20178 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20179 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20180 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20181
20182
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200201838.2.4. Custom log format
20184------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020185
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020186The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020187mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020188
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020189HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020190Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20191separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20192prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20193
20194Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20195variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020196("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020197
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020198If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020199as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020200less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20201the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20202
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020203Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20204"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20205delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20206preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020207
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020208Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20209'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20210https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20211such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20212
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020213Flags are :
20214 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020215 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020216 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20217 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020218
20219 Example:
20220
20221 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20222 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20223
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020224 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20225
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020226At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20227
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020228 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20229 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020230
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020231the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020232
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020233 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20234 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20235 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020236
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020237and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20238
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020239 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20240 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020241
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020242Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20243
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020244 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020245 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020246 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20247 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20248 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020249 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20250 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20251 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020252 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020253 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020254 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020255 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020256 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020257 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20258 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020259 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020260 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020261 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020262 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020263 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020264 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020265 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020266 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20267 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20268 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20269 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20270 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020271 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020272 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020273 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020274 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020275 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020276 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20277 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020278 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20279 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20280 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020281 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020282 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20283 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020284 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020285 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20286 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20287 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020288 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020289 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020290 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20291 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20292 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20293 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020294 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020295 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020296 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020297 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020298 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020299 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020300 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20301 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20302 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020303 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020304 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20305 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020306 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020307 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20308 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020309 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020310 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020311 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020312 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020313
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020314 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020315
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020316
203178.2.5. Error log format
20318-----------------------
20319
20320When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20321protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20322By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20323"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020324will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020325logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20326
20327The format looks like this :
20328
20329 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20330 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20331 Connection error during SSL handshake
20332
20333 Field Format Extract from the example above
20334 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20335 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20336 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20337 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20338 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20339
20340These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20341failures.
20342
20343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203448.3. Advanced logging options
20345-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020346
20347Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20348just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20349options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20350for more information about their usage.
20351
20352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20354------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020355
20356It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20357haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20358commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20359monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20360ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20361
20362 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20363 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20364 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20365 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20366
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020367 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20368 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020369
20370 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20371 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20372 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20373
20374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203758.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20376----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020377
20378The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20379what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20380or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020381"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020382just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20383log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20384after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20385is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20386with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20387with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20388
20389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20391------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020392
20393Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20394for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20395"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20396retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20397raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20398a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20399file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20400you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20401"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20402
20403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20405--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020406
20407Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20408multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20409them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20410"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20411logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20412error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20413and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20414too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20415useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20416alternative.
20417
20418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204198.4. Timing events
20420------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020421
20422Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20423reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20424the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20425frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020426mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20427addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20428
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020429Timings events in HTTP mode:
20430
20431 first request 2nd request
20432 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20433 t tr t tr ...
20434 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20435 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20436 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20437 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020438 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020439 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20440
20441Timings events in TCP mode:
20442
20443 TCP session
20444 |<----------------->|
20445 t t
20446 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20447 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20448 |<------ Tt ------->|
20449
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020450 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020451 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020452 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20453 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20454 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020455 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020456 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20457 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20458 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20459 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020460
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020461 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20462 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20463 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020464 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20465 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20466 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20467 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20468 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20469 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020470
20471 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20472 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20473 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20474 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20475 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20476 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20477 request typed by hand during a test.
20478
20479 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20480 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020481 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020482 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20483 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20484 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20485 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020486
20487 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20488 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20489 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20490 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20491 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20492
20493 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20494 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20495 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20496 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20497 connection never established.
20498
20499 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20500 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20501 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20502 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20503 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20504 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20505 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20506 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20507 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20508 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20509 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20510
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020511 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20512 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20513 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20514 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20515 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20516 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20517
20518 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20519
20520 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20521 "Ta" can never be negative.
20522
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020523 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20524 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020525 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20526 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020527 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020528
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020529 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020530
20531 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020532 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20533 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020534
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020535 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20536 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20537 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20538 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20539 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20540 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20541 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20542 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20543
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020544These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20545protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20546that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020547due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20548"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20549that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020550
20551Most common cases :
20552
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020553 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20554 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20555 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20556 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20557 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20558 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20559 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20560 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20561 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20562 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20563 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020564 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020565
20566 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20567 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20568 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20569 of ms on remote networks.
20570
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020571 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20572 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20573 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020574
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020575 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20576 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20577 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20578 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20579 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20580 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20581 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20582 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20583 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020584
20585Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20586
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020587 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020588 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020589 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020590
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020591 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020592 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20593 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20594
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020595 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020596 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20597 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20598 flags.
20599
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020600 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20601 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020602 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20603 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20604 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20605 the client connection was maintained open.
20606
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020607 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020608 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020609 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020610 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20611
20612
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206138.5. Session state at disconnection
20614-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020615
20616TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20617"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
206182-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20619each of which has a special meaning :
20620
20621 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20622 session to terminate :
20623
20624 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20625
20626 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20627 server explicitly refused it.
20628
20629 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20630 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20631 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20632 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020633 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020634
20635 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20636 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020637
20638 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20639 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20640 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20641 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20642 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20643
20644 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20645 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20646 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20647 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20648 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20649
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020650 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20651 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20652
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020653 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20654 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20655 backup connections when going up.
20656
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020657 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20658
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020659 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20660 send or receive data.
20661
20662 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20663 send or receive data.
20664
20665 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20666 with nothing left in the buffers.
20667
20668 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20669
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020670 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020671 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20672
20673 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20674 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20675 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20676 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20677 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20678
20679 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20680 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20681
20682 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20683 server (HTTP only).
20684
20685 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20686
20687 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20688 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20689 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20690
20691 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20692 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20693 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20694
20695 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20696
20697 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20698 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20699
20700 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20701 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20702 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20703
20704 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20705 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020706 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20707 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020708
20709 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20710 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20711 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20712 another server.
20713
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020714 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020715 server.
20716
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020717 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20718 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20719 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20720 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20721
20722 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20723 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20724 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20725 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20726
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020727 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20728 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20729 "use-server" rule).
20730
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020731 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20732
20733 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20734 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20735
20736 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20737
20738 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20739 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20740 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20741
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020742 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20743 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020744 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020745 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20746 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20747
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020748 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20749
20750 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20751 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20752
20753 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20754
20755 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20756
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020757The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20758was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020759helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20760starvation, attacks, etc...
20761
20762The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20763alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20764easier finding and understanding.
20765
20766 Flags Reason
20767
20768 -- Normal termination.
20769
20770 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20771 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20772 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20773 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20774
20775 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20776 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20777 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20778 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20779 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20780 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020781
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20783 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020784 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020785
20786 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20787 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20788 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20789
20790 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20791 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20792 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20793 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20794 the server takes too long to respond.
20795
20796 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20797 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20798 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20799 long a time to respond.
20800
20801 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20802 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20803 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20804 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020805 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20806 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020807
20808 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20809 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20810 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20811 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20812 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020813 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020814 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20815 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20816 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20817 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20818 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20819 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20820 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20821 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020822 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020823 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20824 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20825 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020826
20827 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20828 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020829 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20830 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20831 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20832 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020833
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020834 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20835 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020837 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020838 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20839 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020840 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020841 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20842 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20843
20844 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20845 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20846 503 or 504 here.
20847
20848 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20849 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20850 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20851 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20852 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20853
20854 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20855 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020856 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020857 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20858 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20859
20860 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20861 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20862 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20863 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20864 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20865 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20866 between haproxy and the server.
20867
20868 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20869 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20870 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20871 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20872 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20873 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20874 solution is to fix the application.
20875
20876 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20877 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20878 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20879 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20880 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20881 external attacks.
20882
20883 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020884 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020885 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020886 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20887 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20888
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020889 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20890 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20891 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020892 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020893 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020894
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020895 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20896 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20897 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20898 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020899 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20900 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20901 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20902 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20903 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020904
20905 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20906 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20907 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20908 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20909
20910 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20911 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20912 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20913 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20914
20915 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20916 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20917 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20918 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20919
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020920The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20921persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20922important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20923re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20924
20925 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20926
20927 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20928 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20929 set on a GET request.
20930
20931 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20932 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020933 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020934 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20935
20936 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20937 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20938 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20939
20940 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20941 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20942 already got a cookie.
20943
20944 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20945 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20946 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20947 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20948 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20949
20950 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20951 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20952 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20953
20954 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20955 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20956 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20957
20958 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20959 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20960
20961 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20962 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20963 then advertised in the response.
20964
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209668.6. Non-printable characters
20967-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020968
20969In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20970consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20971converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20972prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20973being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20974escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20975is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20976'}' when logging headers.
20977
20978Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20979issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20980containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20981
20982Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20983the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20984performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20985
20986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209878.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20988---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020989
20990Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20991achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020992section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020993cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20994the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20995the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020996locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020997not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20998user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20999a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21000wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21001
21002 Examples :
21003 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21004 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21005
21006 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21007 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21008
21009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210108.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21011---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021012
21013Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21014proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21015the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21016server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21017
21018Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21019response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021020section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021021
21022It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021023time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21024appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021025are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21026and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21027follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21028request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21029in the logs.
21030
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021031As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21032frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21033an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21034
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021035 Example :
21036 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21037 listen proxy-out
21038 mode http
21039 option httplog
21040 option logasap
21041 log global
21042 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21043
21044 # log the name of the virtual server
21045 capture request header Host len 20
21046
21047 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21048 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21049
21050 # log the beginning of the referrer
21051 capture request header Referer len 20
21052
21053 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21054 capture response header Server len 20
21055
21056 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21057 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21058
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021059 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021060 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21061
21062 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21063 capture response header Via len 20
21064
21065 # log the URL location during a redirection
21066 capture response header Location len 20
21067
21068 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21069 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21070 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21071 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21072 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21073
21074 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21075 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21076 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21077 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021078 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021079
21080 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21081 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21082 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21083 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21084 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021085 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021086
21087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210888.9. Examples of logs
21089---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021090
21091These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21092them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21093reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21094
21095 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21096 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21097 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21098
21099 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21100 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21101
21102 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21103 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21104 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21105
21106 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21107 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21108
21109 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21110 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21111 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21112
21113 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021114 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021115 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21116 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21117
21118 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21119 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21120 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21121
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021122 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21123 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21124 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21125 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21126 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21127 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021128
21129 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021130 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021131
21132 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21133 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21134 Nothing was sent to any server.
21135
21136 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21137 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21138
21139 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21140 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021141 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021142 send a 408 return code to the client.
21143
21144 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21145 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21146
21147 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21148 5 seconds ("c----").
21149
21150 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21151 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021152 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021153
21154 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021155 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021156 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21157 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21158 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21159 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21160 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021161
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021162
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200211639. Supported filters
21164--------------------
21165
21166Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21167accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21168unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21169
21170See also : "filter"
21171
211729.1. Trace
21173----------
21174
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021175filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021176
21177 Arguments:
21178 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21179 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21180
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021181 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021182
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021183 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021184 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21185 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21186 amount of the parsed data.
21187
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021188 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021189
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021190This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21191callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21192information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21193filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21194
21195Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21196tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21197a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21198
21199
212009.2. HTTP compression
21201---------------------
21202
21203filter compression
21204
21205The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21206keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021207when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21208fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21209done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21210explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21211filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21212listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21213order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021214
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021215See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21216 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021217
21218
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200212199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21220--------------------------------------------
21221
21222filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21223
21224 Arguments :
21225
21226 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21227 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21228 parsed.
21229
21230 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21231 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21232 part must be placed in its own scope.
21233
21234The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21235external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021236streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021237exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21238also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21239
21240SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21241the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21242
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021243For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021244"doc/SPOE.txt".
21245
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100212469.4. Cache
21247----------
21248
21249filter cache <name>
21250
21251 Arguments :
21252
21253 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21254
21255The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21256"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021257cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021258other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21259case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21260is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21261filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021262listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21263order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021264
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021265See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21266 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21267
21268
212699.5. Fcgi-app
21270-------------
21271
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021272filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021273
21274 Arguments :
21275
21276 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21277
21278The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21279request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21280reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21281used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21282implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21283used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21284fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21285used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21286order.
21287
21288See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21289 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21290
21291
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100212929.6. OpenTracing
21293----------------
21294
21295The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21296HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21297of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21298Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21299
21300This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21301
21302The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21303HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21304participates in the work of HAProxy.
21305
21306filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21307
21308 Arguments :
21309
21310 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21311 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21312 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21313 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21314 OpenTracing filters.
21315
21316 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21317 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21318 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21319 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21320 filter must have its own scope defined.
21321
21322More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021323of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021324
21325
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002132610. FastCGI applications
21327-------------------------
21328
21329HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21330feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21331the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21332FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21333servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21334FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21335backend.
21336
21337HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21338application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21339connection.
21340
2134110.1. Setup
21342-----------
21343
2134410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21345--------------------------
21346
21347fcgi-app <name>
21348 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21349 document root must be defined.
21350
21351acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21352 Declare or complete an access list.
21353
21354 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21355 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21356 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21357 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21358 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21359
21360docroot <path>
21361 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21362 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21363 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21364
21365index <script-name>
21366 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21367 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21368 is an optional setting.
21369
21370 Example :
21371 index index.php
21372
21373log-stderr global
21374log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021375 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021376 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21377
21378 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21379 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21380
21381pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21382 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21383 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21384 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21385
21386 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21387 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21388 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21389 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21390
21391 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21392 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21393
21394path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021395 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021396 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21397 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21398 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21399 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21400 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21401 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21402 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021403
21404 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021405 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021406 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21407 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21408 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21409 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021410
21411 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021412 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21413 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021414
21415option get-values
21416no option get-values
21417 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21418
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021419 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021420 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21421
21422 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21423 application will accept.
21424
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021425 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21426 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021427
21428 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021429 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021430 option is disabled.
21431
21432 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21433 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21434 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21435 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21436 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21437 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21438
21439option keep-conn
21440no option keep-conn
21441 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21442 sending a response.
21443
21444 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21445 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21446
21447option max-reqs <reqs>
21448 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21449 accept.
21450
21451 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21452 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21453 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21454 to 1.
21455
21456option mpxs-conns
21457no option mpxs-conns
21458 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21459
21460 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21461 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21462
21463set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21464 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21465 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21466 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21467 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21468
21469 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21470 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21471 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21472
21473 Example :
21474 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21475 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21476
21477 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21478
21479
2148010.1.2. Proxy section
21481---------------------
21482
21483use-fcgi-app <name>
21484 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21485
21486 Arguments :
21487 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21488
21489 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21490 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21491 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21492 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21493 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21494
21495 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21496 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21497 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21498 application are evaluated.
21499
21500
2150110.1.3. Example
21502---------------
21503
21504 frontend front-http
21505 mode http
21506 bind *:80
21507 bind *:
21508
21509 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21510 default_backend back-static
21511
21512 backend back-static
21513 mode http
21514 server www A.B.C.D:80
21515
21516 backend back-dynamic
21517 mode http
21518 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21519 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21520
21521 fcgi-app php-fpm
21522 log-stderr global
21523 option keep-conn
21524
21525 docroot /var/www/my-app
21526 index index.php
21527 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21528
21529
2153010.2. Default parameters
21531------------------------
21532
21533A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21534the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021535script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021536applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21537
21538 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21539 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21540 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21541 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21542 | | |
21543 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21544 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21545 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21546 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21547 | | application. |
21548 | | |
21549 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21550 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21551 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21552 | | |
21553 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21554 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21555 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21556 | | the application's configuration. |
21557 | | |
21558 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21559 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21560 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21561 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21562 | | |
21563 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21564 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21565 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21566 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21567 | | be defined. |
21568 | | |
21569 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21570 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21571 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21572 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21573 | | is not set too. |
21574 | | |
21575 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21576 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21577 | | set. |
21578 | | |
21579 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21580 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21581 | | the request. |
21582 | | |
21583 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21584 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21585 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21586 | | |
21587 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21588 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21589 | | script to process the request. |
21590 | | |
21591 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21592 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21593 | | |
21594 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21595 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21596 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21597 | | |
21598 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21599 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21600 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21601 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21602 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21603 | | |
21604 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21605 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21606 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21607 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21608 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21609 | | side. |
21610 | | |
21611 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21612 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21613 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21614 | | connected to. |
21615 | | |
21616 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21617 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21618 | | |
21619 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21620 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21621 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21622 | | |
21623 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21624
21625
2162610.3. Limitations
21627------------------
21628
21629The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21630way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21631during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21632establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21633application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21634or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21635message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21636these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21637and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21638
21639Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21640request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21641requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21642
21643About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21644into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21645fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21646"http-request" ones.
21647
21648Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21649FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21650processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21651must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21652here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021653
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021654
2165511. Address formats
21656-------------------
21657
21658Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21659address.
21660
21661This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21662The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21663of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21664equivalent is '::'.
21665
21666Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21667is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21668
21669This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21670family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21671
21672Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21673configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21674use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21675'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21676
21677Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21678socket type and the transport method.
21679
21680
2168111.1 Address family prefixes
21682----------------------------
21683
21684'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21685
21686'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21687 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21688 listening.
21689
21690'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21691 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21692 on the statement using this address, a port or
21693 a port range may or must be specified.
21694
21695'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21696 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21697 using this address, a port or a port range
21698 may or must be specified.
21699
21700'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21701 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21702 using this address, a port or a port range
21703 may or must be specified.
21704
21705'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21706 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21707 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21708 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21709 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21710 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21711
21712'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21713 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21714 start by slash '/'.
21715
21716
2171711.2 Socket type prefixes
21718-------------------------
21719
21720Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21721type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21722this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21723This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21724but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21725
21726Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21727instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21728
21729If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21730they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21731report this to the maintainers.
21732
21733'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21734 to "stream"
21735
21736'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21737 to "datagram".
21738
21739
2174011.3 Protocol prefixes
21741----------------------
21742
21743'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21744 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21745 socket type and transport method is forced to
21746 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21747 this address, a port or a port range can or
21748 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21749 of 'stream+ip@'.
21750
21751'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21752 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21753 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21754 statement using this address, a port or port
21755 range can or must be specified.
21756 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21757
21758'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21759 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21760 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21761 statement using this address, a port or port
21762 range can or must be specified.
21763 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21764
21765'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21766 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21767 socket type and transport method is forced to
21768 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21769 this address, a port or a port range can or
21770 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21771 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21772
21773'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21774 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21775 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21776 the statement using this address, a port or
21777 port range can or must be specified.
21778 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21779
21780'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21781 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21782 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21783 the statement using this address, a port or
21784 port range can or must be specified.
21785 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21786
21787'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21788 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21789 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21790
21791'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21792 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21793 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21794
21795In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21796QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021798/*
21799 * Local variables:
21800 * fill-column: 79
21801 * End:
21802 */